1st CHECK
OWNER’S MANUAL
Integrated High Definition
DLP Projection Television
™
Compatible with the new Toshiba
TM
Audio/Video Hard Drive Recorder!
See pages 26 and 55 for details.
HIGH-DEFINITION TELEVISION
Note: A high definition tuner and programming are required
to view High Definition TV broadcasts. Please contact your
cable or satellite provider.
For an overview of steps for setting up
and using your new TV, see page 10.
I
Owner’s Record
The model number and serial number are on the back
of your TV. Record these numbers in the spaces below.
Refer to these numbers whenever you communicate
with your Toshiba dealer about this TV.
56MX195
62MX195
72MX195
Model number:
Serial number:
© 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION
All Rights Reserved
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
16) WARNING: This product contains a lamp to project
Important Safety Instructions
the picture, and requires special safety precautions:
1) Read these instructions.
2) Keep these instructions.
3) Heed all warnings.
• See pages 117–119 for instructions on lamp unit
replacement and care.
• DO NOT attempt to service this product except as
specified on pages 117–119. The only user-
serviceable item in this product is the lamp unit.
4) Follow all instructions.
5) Do not use this apparatus near water.
6) Clean only with a dry cloth.
Installation, Care, and Service
Installation
7) Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in
accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions.
Follow these recommendations and precautions and heed all
warnings when installing your TV:
8) Do not install near any heat sources such as radiators,
heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including
amplifiers) that produce heat.
17) Never modify this equipment. Changes or modifications
may void: a) the warranty, and b) the user’s authority to
operate this equipment under the rules of the Federal
Communications Commission.
9) Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or
grounding type plug. A polarized plug has two blades
with one wider than the other. A grounding type plug has
two blades and a third grounding
Wide blade
prong. The wide blade or the third
prong are provided for your safety.
If the provided plug does not fit into
your outlet, consult an electrician
for replacement of the obsolete outlet.
18)
DANGER: RISK OF SERIOUS PERSONAL
INJURY, DEATH, OR EQUIPMENT
DAMAGE! Never place the TV on
an unstable cart, stand, or table. The TV
may fall, causing serious personal injury,
death, or serious damage to the TV.
10) Protect the power cord from being
walked on or pinched, particularly at
plugs, convenience receptacles, and
the point where it exits the apparatus.
19) Never place or store the TV in direct sunlight; hot, humid
areas; areas subject to excessive dust or vibration; or
locations with temperatures at or below 41°F (5°C).
11) Only use attachments/accessories specified by the
manufacturer.
20) Always place the TV on the floor or a sturdy, level, stable
surface that can support the weight of the unit.
12) Use only with the cart, stand, tripod,
bracket, or table specified by the
manufacturer, or sold with the
21) Never expose the apparatus to dripping or splashing or
place items such as vases, aquariums, any other item filled
with liquid, or candles on top of the TV.
apparatus. When a cart is used, use
caution when moving the cart/apparatus
combination to avoid injury from tip-over.
13) Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or
22) Always place the back of the television at least one (1)
inch away from any vertical surface (such as a wall) to
allow proper ventilation.
when unused for long periods of time.
14) Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel.
Servicing is required when the apparatus has been
damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or plug
is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects have fallen
into the apparatus, the apparatus has been exposed to
rain or moisture, does not operate normally, or has been
dropped.
23) Never block or cover the slots or openings in the TV
cabinet back, bottom, and sides. Never place the TV:
• on a bed, sofa, rug, or similar surface;
• too close to drapes, curtains, or walls; or
14a) Item 14 does not apply to “Lamp unit replacement and
• in a confined space such as a bookcase, built-in cabinet,
or any other place with poor ventilation.
care” on pages 119-121 of this manual.
The slots and openings are provided to protect the TV
from overheating and to help maintain reliable operation
of the TV.
14b) CAUTION: If the TV is dropped and the cabinet or
enclosure surface has been damaged or the TV does
not operate normally, take the following precautions:
• ALWAYS turn off the TV and unplug the power cord to
24) Never allow anything to rest on or roll over the power
cord, and never place the TV where the power cord is
subject to wear or abuse.
avoid possible electric shock or fire.
• To prevent personal injury, never handle the damaged
television.
• ALWAYS contact a service technician to inspect the TV
any time it has been damaged or dropped.
25) Never overload wall outlets and extension cords.
26) Always operate this equipment from a 120 VAC, 60 Hz
power source only.
15) CAUTION: To reduce the risk of electric shock, do not
use the polarized plug with an extension cord, receptacle,
or other outlet unless the blades can be inserted completely
to prevent blade exposure.
(continued on next page)
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Installation (continued from previous page)
Care (continued from previous column)
33) For added protection of your TV from lightning and power
surges, always unplug the power cord and disconnect the
antenna from the TV if you leave the TV unattended or
unused for long periods of time.
27) Always make sure the antenna system is properly
grounded to provide adequate protection against voltage
surges and built-up static charges (see Section 810 of the
National Electric Code).
Antenna lead-in wire
34) During normal use, the TV may make occasional snapping
or popping sounds. This is normal, especially when the
unit is being turned on or off. If these sounds become
frequent or continuous, unplug the power cord
Antenna discharge unit
(NEC Section 810-20)
Ground clamp
and contact a Toshiba Authorized Service Center.
Grounding conductors
(NEC Section 810-21)
35) Special care for DLP™ (digital light Processing) units:
Electric ser vice equipment
Lamp-The in this product has a limited service life. The
length of service life varies depending on product use
or user settings. If you use the lamp beyond its service
life:
•
Power service grounding
electrode system (NEC Art 250 Par
Ground clamps
you may notice a reduction in the colors and/or
brightness of the picture, at which time you should
replace the lamp unit; and
•
•
28)
DANGER: RISK OF SERIOUS PERSONAL
INJURY OR DEATH!
• Use extreme care to make sure you are never in
a position where your body (or any item you are in contact
with, such as a ladder or screwdriver) can accidentally
touch overhead power lines. Never locate the antenna
near overhead power lines or other electrical circuits.
• Never attempt to install any of the following during
lightning activity: a) an antenna system; or b) cables,
wires, or any home theater component connected to an
antenna or phone system.
the strength of the quartz glass in the lamp will be
reduced and the lamp may rupture. If the lamp
ruptures, the TV will not operate until the lamp unit is
replaced.
See “Lamp unit replacement and care” on pages 119–121.
• Dispose of the used lamp unit by the approved method for
your area.
•
The lamp unit contains mercury. Disposal of
mercury may be regulated due to environmental
considerations. For disposal or recycling
information, please contact your local authorities or
the Electronic Industries Alliance (www.eiae.org).
Care
For better performance and safer operation of your TOSHIBA
TV, follow these recommendations and precautions:
Service
36
)
WARNING: RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK!
Never attempt to service the TV yourself,
29) Always sit approximately 10–25 feet away from the TV and
as directly in front of it as possible. The picture can appear
dull if you sit too far to the left or right of the TV, or if
sunlight or room lights reflect on the screen. Turn the TV
off to check for reflections on the screen, and then remove
the source of reflections while viewing the TV.
except as specified on pages 119–121.
Opening and removing the covers may expose you to
dangerous voltage or other hazards. Failure to follow this
WARNING may result in death or serious injury. Refer all
servicing not specified in this manual to a Toshiba Authorized
Service Center.
30) Always unplug the TV before cleaning. Never use liquid or
aerosol cleaners. Clean only with a soft, dry cloth.
37) If you have the TV serviced:
• Ask the service technician to use only replacement parts
specified by the manufacturer.
Do not spray volatile compounds, such as insecticide, on
the cabinet. This may discolor or damage the cabinet.
• Upon completion of service, ask the service technician to
perform routine safety checks to determine that the TV is
in safe operating condition.
31)
WARNING: RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK!
Never spill liquids or push objects of any
kind into the TV cabinet slots.
38) When the TV reaches the end of its useful life, ask a
qualified service technician to properly dispose of the TV.
Note: The lamp unit contains mercury. Disposal of mercury may
be regulated due to environmental considerations. Dispose of
the used lamp unit by the approved method for your area.
For disposal or recycling information, please contact your local
authorities or the Electronic Industries Alliance (www.eiae.org).
32) If the air temperature rises suddenly (for example, when
the TV is first delivered), condensation may form on the
lenses. This can make the picture appear distorted or the
color appear faded. If this happens, turn off the TV for 6 to
7 hours to allow the condensation to evaporate.
_______________
Digital Light Processing, DLP™ and the DLP medallion are
trademarks of Texas Instruments.
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
FCC Declaration of Conformity Compliance Statement (Part 15):
there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular
The Toshiba 56MX195/62MX195/72MX195 DLP™
projection TV complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.
installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to
radio or television reception, which can be determined by removing
and applying power to the equipment, the user is encouraged to try
to correct the interference by one or more of the following
measures:
Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1)
this device may not cause harmful interference, and (2)
this device must accept any interference that may cause
undesired operation.
- Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
The party responsible for compliance to these rules is:
Toshiba America Consumer Products, L.L.C.
82 Totowa Rd. Wayne, NJ 07470.
- Increase the separation between the equipment and the
receiver.
- Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different
from that to which the receiver is connected.
Ph: (973) 628-8000
Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with
the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC
rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection
against harmful interference in a residential installation. This
equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy
and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions,
may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However,
- Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician
for help.
CAUTION: Changes or modifications to this equipment not
expressly approved by Toshiba could void the user’s authority to
operate this equipment.
Important notes about your DLPTM projection TV
1) The light source for this TV is a projection lamp unit with a
limited service life. When the lamp wears out, the picture may
become dark or black or the lamp may fail, at which time you
must replace the lamp unit. See “Lamp unit replacement and
care” on pages 119–121.
5) Depending on the media you are viewing, it is possible, although
unlikely, that a limited number of viewers may see a “rainbow
effect” on the screen, which can, in rare instances, result in eye
fatigue. This is a rare occurrence related to technology of this
type, and is not a sign of TV malfunction.
2) If you set the lamp mode to Low Power, each time you turn on
the TV, the lamp will start out in High Bright mode but will
switch to Low Power mode in approximately 1 minute. You will
notice a change in screen brightness when this happens. This is
normal and is not a malfunction. not a malfunction. (See page
80 for details.)
6) Always sit approximately 10–25 feet away from the TV and as
directly in front of it as possible. The picture quality may be
affected by your viewing position and length of viewing time. If
you sit too closely to the TV for too long, you may suffer from
eye fatigue. See item 29 on page 4.
7)
This TV contains several cooling fans to moderate the
internal temperature. You may be able to hear the fans
for several minutes after the TV is turned off. This is a
function of the Quick Restart standby mode and is not a sign of
TV malfunction. You can set the Quick Restart feature to stop
the fans as soon as the TV is turned off. See “Setting the Quick
Restart feature” on page 56.
3) Each time you turn on the TV, it may take several minutes to go
from no picture to full picture brightness.
4) The display on this TV is manufactured using a chip that may
contain up to 1.3 million microscopic mirrors. Each of these
micromirrors measures less than one-fifth the width of a human
hair and represents a single pixel on the television display.
These micromirrors are mounted on tiny hinges that enable
them to tilt either toward the light source (ON) or away
from it (OFF). Occasionally, one of these mirrors may become
inoperative, creating a light or dark pixel on the projection
surface. This is a structural property of DLP™ projection TV
technology, and is not a sign of malfunction. Such pixels are
not visible when the picture is viewed from a normal viewing
distance (see item 29 on page 4).
8) The yellow and blue LED lights at the bottom center of the TV
front indicate your TV’s current status. If either light flashes, see
“LED indications” on page 115 for details.
9) When you turn on the TV after connecting the power cord,
“Now Booting…” will be displayed on the screen until the
picture appears or the yellow LED will blink until the TV turns
into standby mode.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Important Safety Information ............................................. 2-4
FCC Declaration of Conformity Compliance Statement
(Part 15): .................................................................................... 5
Important notes about your DLP™ projection TV............... 5
Chapter 1: Introduction .......................................................... 8
Chapter 5: TV Guide On Screen™ setup............................ 42
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen™ system ..................... 42
TV Guide On Screen™ Reminder ...................................... 45
Turning off the TV Guide On Screen™
automatic display feature ................................................ 45
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV ............................................. 46
Selecting the menu language............................................... 46
Configuring the antenna input sources ............................... 46
Programming channels into the TV’s channel memory....... 47
Programming channels automatically .......................... 47
Manually adding and deleting channels in the
Welcome to Toshiba ...........................................................
Features of your new TV ....................................................
8
8
Overview of steps for installing, setting up, and
using your new TV .................................................... 10
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV ......................................... 11
TV front and side panel controls and connections ............ 11
TV back panel connections ................................................ 12
Overview of cable types ...................................................... 14
About the connection illustrations ...................................... 15
Connecting a digital CableCARD™ .................................... 15
Connecting a VCR and antenna or Cable TV
channel memory ..................................................... 48
Programming your favorite channels .................................. 49
Setting up and using TheaterNet™ on-screen
device control ................................................................. 50
Setting up TheaterNet................................................. 50
Using the TheaterNet control icons............................. 51
TheaterNet IR device codes .................................. 52–54
Setting the AVHD device skip time .................................... 55
Setting the HDMI™ audio mode........................................ 55
Setting the time and date .................................................... 55
Viewing the CableCARD™ menu ...................................... 56
Setting the Quick Restart feature ........................................ 56
Viewing the digital signal meter ......................................... 57
Viewing the system status ................................................... 57
(no Cable box) ............................................................... 16
Connecting a camcorder..................................................... 16
Connecting a VCR and Cable box ..................................... 17
Connecting a VCR and satellite receiver ............................. 18
Connecting a DVD player with S-video, a VCR,
and a Cable box.............................................................. 19
Connecting a DVD player with ColorStream®
(component video) and a VCR ....................................... 20
Connecting two VCRs ....................................................... 21
Connecting an HDMI™ or a DVI device to the
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™
interactive program guide ............................................... 58
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen™ system ..................... 58
Navigating the TV Guide On Screen™ system .................... 59
TV Guide On Screen™ remote control functions ........ 59
Video Window ........................................................... 60
Panel Menus ............................................................... 60
Info Box...................................................................... 61
TV Guide On Screen™ Icons ...................................... 61
TV Guide On Screen™ Services.......................................... 62
LISTINGS screen ....................................................... 62
SEARCH screen.......................................................... 63
RECORDINGS screen ............................................... 65
SCHEDULE screen .................................................... 66
Record features ........................................................... 66
Remind features .......................................................... 68
SETUP screen............................................................. 70
Change system settings .......................................... 70
Change channel display ......................................... 70
Change default options .......................................... 71
HDMI input .................................................................. 22
Connecting a digital audio system ...................................... 23
Connecting an analog audio system.................................... 23
Controlling infrared remote-controlled devices
through the TV (IR pass-through) .................................. 24
Connecting IEEE1394 video devices .................................. 25
Using analog-compatible IEEE1394 devices ................... 25
Supported signals ........................................................... 25
Using TheaterNet™ on-screen device control .................. 25
Connecting an AVHD (external hard drive) or D-VHS
digital recorder ........................................................... 26
IEEE1394 device initialization ....................................... 26
IEEE1394 device management ....................................... 27
G-LINK™ connection ........................................................ 28
Connecting a personal computer (PC) ............................... 29
Connecting a home network .............................................. 30
Chapter 3: Using the remote control ................................. 31
Learning about the remote control ..................................... 31
Installing the remote control batteries................................. 32
Using the remote control MODE button to control
(Continued on next page)
your other devices........................................................... 33
Remote Control functional key chart ................................. 34
Programming the remote control to operate
your other devices........................................................... 36
Multi-brand remote control device codes............................ 38
Chapter 4: Menu layout and navigation ........................... 40
Main menu layout .............................................................. 40
Setup/Installation menu layout ........................................... 41
Navigating the menu system............................................... 41
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
(Continued from previous page)
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features .....................................72
Selecting the video input source to view ............................. 72
Labeling the video input sources......................................... 73
Tuning channels ................................................................. 74
Using the ChannelBrowser ™ ...................................... 74
Tuning your favorite channels ..................................... 76
Tuning to the next programmed channel .................... 76
Tuning to a specific channel (programmed or
Chapter 9: Using the Locks menu....................................... 97
Entering the PIN code ....................................................... 97
If you cannot remember your PIN code ............................. 97
Changing your PIN code ................................................... 97
Blocking TV programs and movies by rating (V-Chip) ......... 98
Blocking channels............................................................... 99
Unlocking programs temporarily ........................................ 99
Locking video inputs .......................................................... 99
Using the GameTimer™ ................................................... 100
Using the control panel lock feature ................................. 100
unprogrammed) ...................................................... 76
Switching between two channels using
Channel Return ...................................................... 76
Switching between two channels using
Chapter 10: Using the memory card JPEG picture viewer/
MP3 audio player ................................................................ 101
Memory card specifications ....................................... 101
Using the JPEG picture viewer .................................. 102
Using the MP3 audio player ..................................... 103
Memory card care and handling ................................ 104
SurfLock™ ............................................................... 76
Selecting the picture size ..................................................... 77
Natural picture size ..................................................... 77
TheaterWide 1 picture size.......................................... 78
TheaterWide 2 picture size.......................................... 78
TheaterWide 3 picture size.......................................... 78
Full picture size ........................................................... 78
Scrolling the TheaterWide® picture .................................... 79
Using the auto aspect ratio feature ...................................... 79
Selecting the cinema mode (480i signals only) .................... 80
Selecting the lamp mode .................................................... 80
Using the POP features ...................................................... 81
Using the POP double-window feature ....................... 81
Switching the speaker audio (main or POP) ................ 82
POP double-window aspect ratio ................................ 82
Using the FREEZE feature ................................................. 83
Using the favorite channel scan feature ............................... 83
Adjusting the picture .......................................................... 84
Selecting the picture mode .......................................... 84
Adjusting the picture quality ....................................... 84
Using the Color Management feature ......................... 85
Using CableClear® DNR (digital noise reduction) ...... 86
Selecting the color temperature ................................... 86
Using MPEG Noise Reduction ................................... 87
Using Dynamic Contrast ............................................ 87
Using the closed caption mode ........................................... 88
Advanced closed captions ............................................ 88
Digital closed captions ................................................ 89
Adjusting the audio ............................................................ 90
Muting the sound ....................................................... 90
Using the digital audio selector ................................... 90
Selecting stereo/SAP broadcasts................................... 90
Adjusting the audio quality ......................................... 91
Using the sub-bass system (SBS) ................................. 91
Using the StableSound® feature ................................... 91
Using the SRS WOW™ surround sound feature .......... 92
Using the Dolby Virtual with SRS TruSurround
Chapter 11: Connecting your TV to the Network.......... 105
Setting up the Network connection .................................. 105
Set up the Email account .................................................. 106
Timer recording via Email ................................................ 107
Using the audio player/picture viewer via network............ 108
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting ............................................. 112
General troubleshooting ................................................... 112
LED indications ............................................................... 115
TV Guide On Screen™ FAQs ................................... 116–118
Chapter 13: Appendix ......................................................... 119
Lamp unit replacement ............................................ 119–121
Specifications ................................................................... 122
Limited United States Warranty ....................................... 123
Limited Canada Warranty ................................................ 124
Index .............................................................................. 126, 127
sound feature .............................................................. 92
Turning off the built-in speakers ................................. 93
Selecting the optical audio output format ................... 93
Setting the On/Off Timer .................................................. 94
Setting the sleep timer ........................................................ 94
Using the PC setting feature ............................................... 95
Displaying the Channel Banner .......................................... 96
Understanding the auto power off feature........................... 96
Understanding the last mode memory feature .................... 96
Using the gray level feature ................................................. 96
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introduction
1
Welcome to Toshiba
Thank you for purchasing this Toshiba TV, one of the innovative DLP™ projection TVs
on the market. The goal of this manual is to guide you through setting up and operating
your TV as quickly as possible.
See “Important notes about your
DLP™ projection TV” on page 5.
• This manual applies to models 56MX195, 62MX195, and 72MX195. Before you start reading, check the model number on the
back of your TV.
• Instructions in this manual are based on using the remote control. You also can use the controls on the TV control panel if they
have the same name as those referred to on the remote control. (MENU on the side panel functions as ENTER when a menu is
on-screen or when the TV Guide On Screen™ system is open.)
• The side panel and back panel provide terminals for connecting other equipment to your TV. See page 11 for TV control panel
and side panel details. See page 12 for back panel details. See pages 14–30 for instructions on connecting other devices to your
TV.
• Please read all safety and operating instructions in this manual carefully, and keep this manual for future reference.
Features of your new TV
The following are just a few of the many exciting features of your new Toshiba widescreen, integrated HD, DLP™ projection TV:
•
•
•
•
Integrated digital tuning (8VSB ATSC and QAM) eliminates the need for a separate digital converter set-top box (in most cases).
TV Guide On Screen™ no-fee interactive program guide (Chapters 5 and 7).
Digital CableCARD™ slot for viewing encrypted digital Cable TV programs (page 15).
Digital recording by connecting a D-VHS digital recording device or a Toshiba Symbio
™
Audio/Video Hard Drive Recorder to
one of the IEEE1394 jacks. You can record high definition and standard definition material from either tuner (page 26).
•
Memory card slots [SD Memory Card, MultiMediaCard, Memory Stick, CompactFlash, xD-PictureCard™] for viewing JPEG
files as a “slide show” (page 102) and for playing MP3 files (page 103).
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
TheaterNet™ icons for on-screen control of external IR and IEEE1394 devices (page 50).
Two IEEE1394 ports for multi-device connection and control (page 25).
Two HDMI (DVI) digital, high-definition multimedia interfaces (page 22).
Two sets of ColorStream® HD high-resolution component video inputs (pages 18 and 20).
Dolby Digital* (page 23) and SRS WOW™ (page 92) audio technologies.
Digital Audio Out optical audio connection (page 23).
Note: After you set up the TV Guide
On Screen™ system (Chapter 5),
the program guide opens
automatically by default when
you turn on the TV. You can turn off
the automatic program guide (page
45) and instead press the TV GUIDE
button on the remote control to
manually open the program guide.
CableClear® DNR digital picture noise reduction (page 86).
• Double-window POP (page 81) and multi-window Favorites (page 83) features.
•
•
PC IN (Analog RGB) computer terminal (page 29).
RJ-45 (THINC™) port terminal (page 30).
______________
In the United States, TV Guide and other related marks are registered marks of Gemstar-TV Guide International, Inc. and/or one of its affiliates. In Canada, TV Guide is a registered
mark of Transcontinental Inc., and is used under license by Gemstar-TV Guide International, Inc. The TV Guide On Screen system is manufactured under license from Gemstar-TV
Guide International, Inc. and/or one of its affiliates. The TV Guide On Screen system is protected by one or more of the following issued United States patents 6,498,895; 6,418,556;
6,331,877; 6,239,794; 6,154,203; 5,940,073; 4,908,713; 4,751,578; 4,706,121.
GEMSTAR-TV GUIDE INTERNATIONAL INC. AND/OR ITS RELATED AFFILIATES ARE NOT IN ANY WAY LIABLE FOR THE ACCURACY OR
AVAILABILITY OF THE PROGRAM SCHEDULE INFORMATION OR OTHER DATA IN THE TV GUIDE ON SCREEN SYSTEM AND CANNOT GUARANTEE
SERVICE AVAILABILITY IN YOUR AREA. IN NO EVENT SHALL GEMSTAR-TV GUIDE INTERNATIONAL, INC. AND/OR ITS RELATED AFFILIATES BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES IN CONNECTION WITH THE ACCURACY OR AVAILABILITY OF THE PROGRAM SCHEDULE INFORMATION OR OTHER
DATA IN THE TV GUIDE ON SCREEN SYSTEM.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 1: Introduction
Features of your new TV (continued)
• A recording device is required for recording. Over-the-air or cable access to stations carrying TV Guide On Screen™ data is required for the TV Guide On Screen™ system to operate.
TV Guide On Screen™ data is not provided by Toshiba America Consumer Products, L.L.C. The provider of the data may elect to discontinue the service or it may cease to be (or never
be) available in your area. In any of these circumstances, the TV Guide On Screen™ feature will not function.
• This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is protected by U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights. Use of this copyright protection technology must be
authorized by Macrovision and is intended for home and other limited pay-per-view uses only, unless otherwise authorized by Macrovision. Reverse engineering or disassembly is
prohibited.
• WOW, TruSurround, SRS and
symbol are trademarks of SRS Labs, Inc. WOW technology is incorporated under license from SRS Labs, Inc.
•
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. “Dolby”, “Pro Logic” and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
*
• CableCARD™ is a trademark of Cable Television Laboratories, Inc.
is a trademark.
•
• MMC and MultiMediaCard are trademarks of Infineon Technologies AG and licensed to MMCA (MultiMediaCard Association).
• Memory Stick is a trademark of Sony Corporation.
• xD-Picture Card is a trademark of Fuji Photo Film Co., Ltd.
• Toshiba is an authorized licensee of the CompactFlash®and CF logo® registered trademarks.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 1: Introduction
Overview of steps for installing, setting up, and using your new TV
Follow these steps to set up your TV and begin using its many exciting features.
1. Carefully read the important safety, installation, care,
and service information on pages 2–5. Keep this
manual for future reference.
9. Program the remote control to operate your other
device(s) (pages 33–39).
10. AFTER connecting all cables and devices, plug in the
2. Observe the following when choosing a location for
power cords for your TV and other devices.
the TV:
11. After you plug in the TV power cord, the yellow LED (on
the TV front) will blink 3 times. Wait about 30 seconds until
the yellow LED lights continuously and then press POWER on
the TV control panel or remote control.
•
Place the TV on the floor or on the optional TV stand listed in
the “Specifications” section (page 122).
NOTICE OF POSSIBLE TV STAND INSTABILITY
DANGER: RISK OF SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY
OR DEATH! Use this TV only with the TOSHIBA TV
See “LED indications” on page 115.
12. See “Menu layout and navigation” for a quick overview
stand listed in the “Specifications” section (page 122). Use with other
stands may result in instability, causing possible injury or death.
of navigating the TV’s menu system (pages 40–41).
13. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide
On Screen™ system (if available in your area).
• Place the TV in a location where light does not reflect on the
screen.
14. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide
On Screen™ program guide (if available in your area).
• Place the TV far enough from walls and other objects to allow
proper ventilation. Inadequate ventilation may cause
overheating, which will damage the TV. THIS TYPE OF
DAMAGE IS NOT COVERED UNDER THE TOSHIBA
WARRANTY.
15. Program channels into the TV’s channel memory
(page 47).
16. Set up the TheaterNet™ on-screen device control
feature (if applicable to your particular home theater system
components) (page 50).
• Read “Installation” on pages 3–4.
• Read “Important notes about your DLP™ TV” on page 5.
17. For details on using the memory card JPEG picture
3. Do not plug in any power cords until AFTER you have
viewer and MP3 audio player, see page 101.
connected all cables and devices to your TV.
18. For details on using the TV’s features, see Chapter 8.
4. BEFORE connecting cables or devices to the TV, learn
the functions of the TV’s connections and controls (pages 11
and 12).
19. For help, refer to the Troubleshooting Guide (Chapter
12).
20. For technical specifications and warranty information,
5. Connect your other electronic device(s) to the TV
see Chapter 13.
(pages 15–30).
21. Enjoy your new TV!
6. Connect the G-LINK™ cable (either one of the enclosed IR
blaster cables) from your VCR and/or Cable box (if applicable) to
the G-LINK™ terminal so you can use the TV Guide On Screen™
features (applies to VCRs and cable boxes only). See page 28.
Note: If you sell or transfer this television to a third party, be sure
to reset the PIN code as described on page 97 under the heading,
“If you cannot remember your PIN code.”
7. Install the batteries in the remote control (page 33).
8. See “Learning about the remote control” (page 31) for
an overview of the buttons on the remote control.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your TV
2
TV front and side panel controls and connections
Front of TV
Right side of TV
Side panel
Remote sensor
1
Memory card
slots !™
VIDEO-3 IN
!¡
POWER
Yellow/Blue LEDs
6
0
MENU (ENTER)*
5
Channel
7
yzx • 4
Volume + –
8
EXIT
3
TV/VIDEO
2
GUIDE
9
* The MENU button on the TV control panel functions as the ENTER
button when a menu is on-screen.
Control panel
1
2
Remote sensor (behind the screen) — Point the remote
control toward this area of the TV screen. See “Remote
control effective range” on page 32.
8
VOLUME + – — When no menu is on-screen, these
buttons adjust the volume level. When a menu is on-screen,
these buttons function as left/right menu navigation
buttons.
GUIDE — Press to access the TV Guide On Screen™
program guide. (See page 58 for details on using the
program guide.)
TV/VIDEO — Repeatedly press to change the source you are
viewing (ANT 1, ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3,
HDMI 1, HDMI 2, ColorStream HD1, ColorStream HD2,
PC).
9
0
3
4
EXIT — Press to close an on-screen menu instantly.
Yellow and Blue LEDs
ARROWS yzx • — When a menu is on-screen, these
buttons function as up/down/left/right menu navigation
buttons.
When the yellow LED lights solid (not blinking), it indicates
that recording is in progress.
When the blue LED lights solid (not blinking), it indicates
that the TV power cord is plugged in.
5
6
MENU (ENTER) — Press to access the menu system (see
page 40). When a menu is on-screen or the TV Guide
On Screen™ program guide is open, the MENU button on
the control panel functions as the ENTER button.
See “LED indications” on page 115 for additional
information.
!¡ VIDEO-3 — The side panel A/V connections are referred to
as “VIDEO 3” and include standard A/V connections plus
optional S-video. (The VIDEO 1 and VIDEO 2 A/V
connections are on the TV’s back panel; see page 12.
POWER — Press to turn the TV on and off.
If the TV stops responding to the controls on the remote
control or TV control panel and you cannot turn off the TV,
press and hold the POWER button on the TV front panel
for 5 or more seconds to reset the TV.
!™ Memory card slots — Insert a memory card into one of
the memory card slots to view JPEG files (such as photos) as
a “slide show” on your TV or listen to MP3 audio files (see
page 101).
7
CHANNEL
— When no menu is on-screen, these
buttons change the channel (programmed channels only; see
page 47). When a menu is on-screen, these buttons function
as up/down menu navigation buttons.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
TV back panel connections
For an explanation of cable types, see page 14.
1
2
3 4
5
6
7
8
!∞
!¢
!£ !™
!¡ !º
9
1 VIDEO 1 IN and VIDEO 2 IN — Two sets of standard
(composite) video and standard audio inputs plus optional
S-video inputs for connecting devices with composite video
or S-video output.
8
TheaterNet™ (IR) OUT — For controlling infrared remote-
controlled devices through the TV. You can connect up to two
devices with either one of the enclosed IR blaster cables, and then
control the devices using the TV’s IR pass-through or TheaterNet™
(on-screen device control) features. See pages 24 and 50.
TheaterNet™ (IR) IN — For connecting to IR OUT on other
devices. See page 24.
Note: Standard (composite) video and S-video cables carry
only video information; separate audio cables are required for a
complete connection.
9 CableCARD™ slot — For use with a digital security card
and digital cable TV service (provided by your local cable
operator) to view encrypted digital programming. See pages
12 and 51.
2 ColorStream® HD-1 and ColorStream® HD-2 — Two sets
of ColorStream® high-definition component video and
standard stereo audio inputs for connecting devices with
component video output, such as a Toshiba DVD player
with ColorStream®. See pages 15 and 17.
!º Digital Audio OUT — Optical audio output in Dolby Digital
or PCM (pulse-code modulation) format for connecting an
external Dolby Digital decoder, amplifier, A/V receiver, or
home theater system with optical audio input. See page 20.
Note: Component video cables carry only video information;
separate audio cables are required for a complete connection.
3
Variable Audio OUT — Standard analog audio outputs for
connecting an analog amplifier with external speakers. See page 20.
4 A/V OUT — Standard composite video and analog audio
outputs for connecting a VCR for editing and dubbing. See
page 18 for details.
5 HDMI Audio IN — For use when connecting a DVI
device with analog audio output to one of the HDMI
inputs. See page 19. Also see item 10 below.
6 PC AUDIO IN — For use when connecting audio from a
personal computer See page 29.
7 PC IN — For use when connecting a personal computer See
page 29.
___________
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or
registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.
CableCARD is a trademark of Cable Television Laboratories, Inc.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
TV back panel connections (continued)
!¡ RJ-45 (THINC™)* — For use when connecting a home
*THINC™ System (Toshiba Home Interactive Network
Connection) -
network See page 30.
!™ (2) IEEE1394 — Two bi-directional digital IEEE1394
ports for connecting multiple devices with compressed
digital video. Because these ports are bi-directional, they can
be used for playback and recording. You can control your
IEEE1394 devices using the TV’s TheaterNet on-screen
device control icons. See pages 21–24 and 46.
This RJ-45 Port allows select Toshiba Cinema Series TV’s to connect to
a Desktop or Laptop PC. This revolutionary Home Entertainment
Networking System lets you access all of the MP3 audio files or JPEG
pictures stored on your PC, using only the TV remote (without ever
leaving the couch). If your TV is connected to your audio system, you
can even use it to play back all of your MP3 audio files.
Note:
• IEEE1394 cable carries both audio and video information;
separate audio cables are not required.
!£ G-LINK™ — For use with one of the enclosed IR blaster/
G-LINK™ cables to enable the TV Guide On Screen™
recording features. See page 25.
!¢ (2) HDMI™ IN 1 and 2 — Two High-Definition
Multimedia Interface inputs receive digital audio and
uncompressed digital video from an HDMI device or
uncompressed digital video from a DVI device. See page 19.
!∞ ANT-1 (CABLE) IN and ANT-2 IN — Two inputs that
support analog (NTSC) and digital (ATSC) off-air antenna
signals and analog and digital (QAM) Cable TV signals.
Note: If you have an antenna only, connect it to ANT-1. If you have
both cable TV and an antenna, connect the cable TV to ANT-1 and
the antenna to ANT-2.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Overview of cable types
Note: Two dual-wand IR blaster/G-LINK™ cables are included with your TV. All other required
cables, if not provided with your other devices, can be purchased at many electronics accessory
suppliers.
Coaxial (F-type) cable
●
●
Coaxial (F-type) cable is used for connecting your antenna, cable TV service, and/or
cable converter box to the ANT-1 and/or ANT-2 RF inputs on your TV.
Standard A/V cables (composite video) usually come in sets of three, and are for use
with video devices with standard audio and standard (composite) video output. These
cables (and the related inputs on your TV) are typically color-coded according to use:
yellow for video, red for stereo right audio, and white for stereo left (or mono) audio.
Standard A/V cables (red/white/yellow)
S-video cable
●
●
S-video cable is for use with video devices with S-video output. Separate audio cables
are required for a complete connection.
Note: An S-video cable provides better picture performance than a composite video cable. If
you connect an S-video cable, be sure to disconnect the standard (composite) video cable or
the picture performance will be unacceptable.
Component video cables (red/green/blue)
Component video cables come in sets of three and are for use with video devices with
component video output. (ColorStream® is Toshiba’s brand of component video.)
These cables are typically color-coded red, green, and blue. Separate audio cables are
required for a complete connection.
HDMI cable
Note: Component video cables provide better picture performance than a standard (composite)
video or S-video cable.
●
●
HDMI cable is for use with devices with HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia
Interface) output. HDMI cable delivers digital audio and video in its native format.
This cable carries both video and audio information; therefore, separate audio cables are
not required for a complete HDMI device connection. See page 19 for further details.
IEEE1394 cable (4-pin)
Note: HDMI cable provides better picture performance than a standard (composite) video or
S-video cable.
Dual-wand IR blaster/G-LINK® cable
(2 included)
IEEE1394 cable is for use with video devices with compressed digital video output
that meet CEA specifications for IEEE1394. This cable carries both video and audio
information; therefore, no separate audio cables are required for a complete connection.
See pages 22–24.
Note:
Optical audio cable
RJ-45 (LAN) cable
• The transmission capability of any IEEE1394 cable used with this TV must be S400
(400 Mbps maximum).
• IEEE1394 cable provides better picture performance than a standard (composite)
video or S-video cable.
Dual-wand IR blaster/G-LINK™ cable is for use with video devices with IR (infrared)
remote control. Two of these cables are included with your TV. One is for connection
to the G-LINK™ terminal (page 25) to enable TV Guide On Screen™ recording
features (Chapters 5 and 7). The other can be used with the TV’s IR pass-through
feature (page 21) and TheaterNet™ on-screen device control feature (page 45).
●
Note: Although your TV includes both HDMI
and IEEE1394 connections, it may not
operate with another device you have that
includes such a connection. For example, the
IEEE1394 ports are not intended to operate
with current model Mini DV camcorders, and
the HDMI input is not intended for
Note: The two IR blaster/G-LINK™ cables included with your TV have specific characteristics that
allow them to work properly with this TV’s IR OUT and G-LINK™ ports. Never use other
aftermarket IR blaster or G-LINK™ cables with this TV. Other cables may not function
properly and can cause damage. THIS TYPE OF DAMAGE IS NOT COVERED BY YOUR
TOSHIBA WARRANTY.
●
●
Optical audio cable is for connecting receivers with Dolby Digital or PCM
(pulse-code modulation) optical audio input to the TV’s DIGITAL AUDIO OUT
terminal. See page 20.
connection to a computer. Copyright
protection requirements may also prohibit or
limit connectivity. See page 19 for details
about the HDMI input. See pages 22–24 for
details about the IEEE1394 ports.
RJ-45 (LAN) cable is for used to connect to the Internet. See page 30.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
About the connection illustrations
You can connect different types and brands of devices to your TV in several different configurations. The connection illustrations in
this manual are representative of typical device connections only. The input/output terminals on your devices may differ from those
illustrated herein. For details on connecting and using your specific devices, refer to each device’s owner’s manual.
Connecting a digital CableCARD™
This digital television is capable of receiving analog basic, digital
basic, and digital premium cable television programming by
direct connection to a cable system providing such
programming.
To view encrypted digital channels:
ꢀ
1. Connect your digital Cable TV cable to ANT-1.
2. With the front of the CableCARD™ facing up, insert it into
the CableCARD™ slot on the back of the TV (see
illustration below left).
3. After the CableCARD™ is inserted, a CableCARD™ option
appears in the Applications menu, with informational
screens provided by your digital CableCARD™ service. See
page 51 for additional information.
A security card (such as a digital CableCARD™), provided by
your cable operator, is required to view encrypted digital
programming.
Certain advanced and interactive digital cable services (such as
video-on-demand, a cable operator’s enhanced program guide,
and data-enhanced television services) will not work with the
use of a CableCARD™ and may require the use of a separate set-
top box from your cable operator.
CableCard Connected -- Acquiring
channel information.
Applications
For more information, call your local cable operator.
CableCard services will only operate
TV Guide On Screen
Audio Player
IP Service
with cable signal connected to Antenna 1.
Conditional Access
CableCARD(tm) Status
Network Setup
You will need:
ꢁ one digital CableCARD™ (contact your cable operator)
Picture Viewer
Digital CC/Audio Selector
CableCARD
CableCARD(tm) Pairing
ꢁ digital cable subscription service (contact your cable
operator)
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
TV back panel
Note:
• Always use the EJECT button to remove the CableCARD™. Never
remove the CableCARD™ by hand.
• Never insert any object or card (including, without limitation, a
PCMCIA card) other than a CableCARD™ into the CableCARD™
slot.
• Always make sure the CableCARD™ is facing the correct direction.
• Connect the cable for your digital cable TV service to ANT-1 only.
• When using a CableCARD™, channel programming is unnecessary
because the CableCARD™ automatically loads the cable channel
list into the TV’s channel memory (page 42).
• The CableCARD™ may take up to 5 minutes to “pair” with the TV
and download channel information. CableCARD™ information and
channels will not be available until this process is completed.
CableCARD™ technology, like all new and emerging technology, may
from time to time experience compatibility issues due to the different
ways in which television manufacturers and cable system operators
implement the CableCARD™ specifications. Most issues can be easily
resolved. In the event that you experience any performance-related
CableCARD™ issues with your Toshiba television, please contact the
following:
• In the U.S., call TACP Consumer Solutions at (800) 631-3811 or visit
http://www.tacp.com/customersupport/contact.asp.
• In Canada, call TCL Customer Service at 1-800-268-3404.
From digital Cable service
(connect to ANT 1 only)
This cable should be connected to ANT 1 terminal directly. If you connect
the cable via a VCR, the TV may not receive the signals correctly.
________
CableCARD is a trademark of Cable Television Laboratories, Inc.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting a VCR and antenna or Cable TV (no Cable box)
You will need:
ꢁ one signal splitter
From Cable TV or antenna
IN
ꢁ three coaxial cables
ꢁ two sets of standard A/V cables
Signal splitter
OUT
OUT
• For better picture performance, if your VCR has S-video, use an
Stereo VCR
S-video cable (plus the audio cables) instead of the standard
video cable. However, do not connect both types of video cables
to VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same time or the picture
performance will be unacceptable.
VIDEO
AUDI
L
IN from ANT
OUT to TV
CH 3
CH 4
IN
OUT
• If you have a mono VCR, connect L/MONO on the TV to your
VCR’s audio out terminal using the white audio cable only.
L
R
TV
To view the antenna or Cable signal:
Select the ANT 1 video input source on the TV.*
ꢀ
ꢀ
To view the VCR:
Turn ON the VCR. Select the VIDEO 1 video input source
on the TV.*
To use the TV Guide On Screen™ recording features:
1. Connect the G-LINK™ cable according to the
instructions on page 25.
ꢀ
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT
terminals on the TV (see illustration).
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your
VCR owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the
VCR.
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the
ANT 1, ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when the
appropriate input mode is selected.
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide
On Screen™ system.
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject
you to civil and criminal liability.
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide
On Screen™ system.
Connecting a camcorder
You will need:
Camcorder
ꢁ one set of standard A/V cables
• For better picture performance, if your camcorder has S-video, use an
S-video cable (plus the audio cables) instead of the standard video cable.
Do not connect both an S-video cable and a standard video cable to VIDEO
3 at the same time or the picture performance will be unacceptable.
VIDEO AUDIO
OUT
L
R
To view the camcorder video:
ꢀ
Select the VIDEO 3 video input source on the TV.*
______________
*
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control (see page 67).
To program the TV remote control to operate other devices, see Chapter 3.
VIDEO 3 inputs on TV right side panel
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting a VCR and Cable box
You will need:
From Cable TV
ꢁ one signal splitter
ꢁ five coaxial cables
ꢁ two sets of standard A/V cables
IN
Cable box
OUT
Signal splitter
OUT
IN
CH 3
CH 4
OUT
Stereo VCR
• For better picture performance from your VCR: If your VCR has
S-video, connect an S-video cable (plus the audio cables) instead
of the standard video cable. Do not connect an S-video cable and
a standard video cable to VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same time
or the picture performance will be unacceptable.
VIDEO
AUDI
L
IN from ANT
CH 3
CH 4
IN
OUT to TV
OUT
L
R
• If you have a mono VCR, connect L/MONO on the TV to your
VCR’s audio out terminal using the white audio cable only.
TV
• When you use a Cable box, you may not be able to use the remote
control to program or access certain features on the TV.
To view basic Cable channels and use the TV’s features:
ꢀ
Select the ANT 1 video input source on the TV.* Use the
TV controls (control panel or remote control) to change
channels and access the TV’s features.
To view basic and premium Cable channels:
ꢀ
Turn OFF the VCR. Select the ANT 2 video input source
on the TV.* Tune the TV to channel 3 or 4 (whichever
channel the Cable box output is set to). Use the Cable box
controls to change channels.
To view the VCR:
ꢀ
Turn ON the VCR. Select the VIDEO 1 video input source
on the TV.*
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the
ANT 1, ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when the
appropriate input mode is selected.
Note: A VIDEO 1 connection with an S-Video cable (instead
of a standard video cable) will provide better picture
performance (as mentioned in the first bulleted item at the
top of this page).
To enable the TV Guide On Screen™ system to work
_____________
ꢀ
*
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control
(see page 67). To program the TV remote control to operate other
devices, see Chapter 3.
with your cable box and to use the TV Guide
On Screen™ recording features:
1. Connect the G-LINK™ cable according to the
instructions on page 25.
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT
terminals on the TV (see illustration).
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject
you to civil and criminal liability.
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your
VCR owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the
VCR.
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide
On Screen™ system.
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide
On Screen™ system.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting a VCR and satellite receiver
From antenna
You will need:
ꢁ one signal splitter
ꢁ four coaxial cables
IN
Signal splitter
OUT
OUT
ꢁ one set of component video cables (if your
satellite receiver does not have component
video, connect the standard A/V cables only)
Stereo VCR
VIDEO
AUDI
L
IN from ANT
OUT to TV
ꢁ one pair of standard audio cables
CH 3
CH 4
IN
ꢁ three sets of standard A/V cables
OUT
L
R
• For better picture performance, if your satellite
receiver and VCR have S-video, connect S-video
cables (plus the audio cables) instead of the standard
video cables. Do not connect both types of video
cable to VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same time or
the picture performance will be unacceptable.
TV
• If you have a mono VCR, connect L/MONO on the
TV (VIDEO 1) to your VCR’s AUDIO OUT terminal
using the white audio cable only.
To view satellite programs using the component video
connections:
ꢀ
Select the ColorStream HD-1 video input source on the
TV.*
From satellite dish
To view satellite programs using the standard
video connections or to record satellite programs:
ꢀ
Satellite receiver
AUDIO
OUT
Turn on all three devices. Set the VCR to the appropriate
line input (refer to your VCR owner’s manual for details).
Select the VIDEO 2 video input source on the TV.*
L
L
Y
P
B
PR
Satellite
IN
R
R
S-VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO
OUT
VIDEO
OUT
To view the VCR or view and record antenna channels:
ꢀ
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the ANT 1,
ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when the appropriate
input mode is selected.
Turn ON the VCR. Tune the VCR to the channel you want
to watch. Select the VIDEO 1 video input source on the
TV.*
To use the TV Guide On Screen™ recording features:
1. Connect the G-LINK™ cable according to the
instructions on page 25.
_____________
ꢀ
*
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control
(see page 67). To program the TV remote control to operate other
devices, see Chapter 3.
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT
terminals on the TV (see illustration).
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject
you to civil and criminal liability.
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your
VCR owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the
VCR.
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide
On Screen™ system.
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide
On Screen™ system.
Note: The TV Guide On Screen™ system does not receive
program listings from or for any satellite service.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting a DVD player with S-video, a VCR, and a Cable box
From antenna or Cable TV
You will need:
ꢁ one signal splitter
ꢁ five coaxial cables
ꢁ two sets of standard A/V cables
IN
Cable box
OUT
Signal splitter
OUT
IN
CH 3
CH 4
OUT
Stereo VCR
Note: If you have a mono VCR, connect L/MONO on the TV
(VIDEO 1) to your VCR’s audio out terminal using the white
audio cable only.
VIDEO
AUDI
L
R
IN from ANT
CH 3
CH 4
IN
OUT to TV
OUT
ꢁ one S-video cable
ꢁ one pair of standard audio cables
Note:
L
R
TV
• If your DVD player does not have S-video, use a standard
video cable instead. Do not connect an S-video cable and a
standard video cable to VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same
time or the picture performance will be unacceptable.
•
•
If your DVD player has component video, see page 17.
Do not connect the DVD player and VCR to the same set of
A/V inputs on the TV. (See the illustration, which shows the
VCR connected to VIDEO 1 on the TV, and the DVD player
connected to VIDEO 2.)
To view basic channels and access the TV’s features:
ꢀ
ꢀ
Select the ANT 1 video input source.* Use the TV
controls to change channels and access the TV’s features.
AUDIO
OUT
L
S-VIDEO
OUT
VIDEO
OUT
R
To view premium Cable channels:
Turn OFF the VCR. Select the ANT 2 video input
source on the TV.* Tune the TV to channel 3 or 4
(whichever channel the Cable box output is set to).
Use the Cable box controls to change channels.
DVD player with S-video
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the ANT 1,
ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when the appropriate input
mode is selected.
Note: When you use a Cable box, you may not be able to
use the remote control to program or access certain
features on the TV.
To view the DVD player:
ꢀ
ꢀ
To enable the TV Guide On Screen™ system to work with
ꢀ
Turn ON the DVD player. Select the VIDEO 2 video
input source on the TV.*
your cable box and to use the TV Guide On Screen™
recording features:
To view the VCR:
1. Connect the G-LINK™ cable according to the instructions on
page 25.
Turn ON the VCR. Select the VIDEO 1 video input
source on the TV.*
_____________
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control
(see page 67). To program the TV remote control to operate other
devices, see Chapter 3.
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT terminals
on the TV (see illustration).
*
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your VCR
owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the VCR.
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide
On Screen™ system.
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of
television programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is
prohibited under the Copyright Laws of the United States and other
countries, and may subject you to civil and criminal liability.
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide On Screen™
system.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting a DVD player with ColorStream® (component video) and a VCR
Your TV has ColorStream® (component video) inputs.
From antenna or Cable
You will need:
IN
Signal splitter
OUT
ꢁ one signal splitter
OUT
ꢁ three coaxial cables
Stereo VCR
ꢁ two sets of standard A/V cables
VIDEO
AUDI
• For better picture performance, if your VCR has S-video, use an
S-video cable (plus the audio cables) instead of the standard
video cable. However, do not connect both types of video cable to
VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same time or the picture
performance will be unacceptable.
L
IN from ANT
OUT to TV
CH 3
CH 4
IN
OUT
L
R
TV
• If you have a mono VCR, connect L/MONO on the TV
(VIDEO 1) to your VCR’s audio out terminal using the white
audio cable only.
ꢁ one pair of standard audio cables
ꢁ one set of component video cables
• You can connect the component video cables (plus audio
cables) from the DVD player to either set of ColorStream
terminals on the TV (HD-1 or HD-2). The ColorStream HD-1
and HD-2 terminals can be used with Progressive (480p,
720p) and Interlaced (480i, 1080i) scan systems. A 1080i
signal will provide the best picture performance.
• If your DVD player does not have component video, see page
16. If your DVD player has HDMI video, see page 19.
AUDIO
OUT
To view antenna or Cable channels:
Y
PB
PR
ꢀ
L
Select the ANT 1 video input source on the TV.*
S-VIDEO
OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO
VIDEO
OUT
R
To view the DVD player:
ꢀ
DVD player with component video
Turn ON the DVD player. Select the ColorStream HD-1
video input source on the TV.*
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the ANT 1,
ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when the appropriate
input mode is selected.
To view the VCR:
ꢀ
Turn ON the VCR. Select the VIDEO 1 video input
source on the TV.*
To record a TV program while watching a DVD:
ꢀ
To use the TV Guide On Screen™ recording features:
1. Connect the G-LINK™ cable according to the
instructions on page 25.
Turn ON the VCR. Tune the VCR to the channel to
record. Select the ColorStream HD-1 video input source
on the TV* to view the DVD.
ꢀ
_____________
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT
terminals on the TV (see illustration).
*
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control
(see page 67). To program the TV remote control to operate other
devices, see Chapter 3.
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your
VCR owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the
VCR.
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject
you to civil and criminal liability.
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide
On Screen™ system.
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide
On Screen™ system.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting two VCRs
From antenna or Cable
You will need:
ꢁ one signal splitter
ꢁ three coaxial cables
ꢁ two sets of standard A/V cables
IN
Signal splitter
OUT
**
OUT
• For better picture performance, if VCR 1 has S-video, use
an S-video cable (plus the audio cables) instead of the
standard video cable. However, do not connect both types
of video cable to VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same time
or the picture performance will be unacceptable.
VCR1 (plays)
VIDEO
AUDIO
L
R
IN from ANT
OUT to TV
CH 3
CH 4
IN
OUT
L
R
• If VCR 1 has mono audio, connect L/MONO on the TV (VIDEO 1)
to the audio out terminal on VCR 1 using the white audio cable
only.
TV
a
• Do not connect the same VCR to the output and input terminals on
the TV at the same time.
To view the antenna or Cable signal:
ꢀ
Select the ANT-1 video input source on the TV.*
b
To view VCR 1:
ꢀ
Turn ON VCR 1. Select the VIDEO 1 video input source
on the TV.*
To dub or edit from VCR 1 to VCR 2:
ꢀ
Turn ON both VCRs. Set VCR 2 to the appropriate line
input (refer to your VCR owner’s manual for details). Select
the VIDEO 1 video input source on the TV.*
VCR2 (records)
VIDEO
AUDI
R
IN from ANT
OUT to TV
CH 3
CH 4
IN
L
Note:
OUT
L
R
• If you have a Cable box, connect the Cable box and splitter to VCR1
as shown on page 14.
L
R
• The VIDEO OUT signal incorporates Macrovision® copyright
protection technology, which may prevent you from recording certain
copy-restricted video materials.***
a
The VIDEO OUT terminal does not output the POP picture.
b
When POP mode is active, the AUDIO OUT terminals output the
sound of the active window (main or POP). For additional
information, see “Notes about recording” on page 76.
_________________________________________________________________
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the
ANT 1, ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when
the appropriate input mode is selected.
*
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control
(see page 67). To program the TV remote control to operate other
devices, see Chapter 3.
** Do not connect the unit through a VCR. Video signals fed through VCRs may be
affected by copyright protection systems and the picture will be distorted on the TV.
To use the TV Guide On Screen™ recording features:
1. Connect the G-LINK™ cable according to the
instructions on page 25.
ꢀ
*** This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is protected by
U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights. Use of this copyright protection
technology must be authorized by Macrovision and is intended for home and other
limited pay-per-view uses only, unless otherwise authorized by Macrovision.
Reverse engineering or disassembly is prohibited. Macrovision is a registered
trademark of Macrovision Corporation.
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT
terminals on the TV (see illustration).
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your
VCR owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the
VCR.
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject
you to civil and criminal liability.
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide
On Screen™ system.
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide
On Screen™ system.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting an HDMI™ or a DVI device to the HDMI input
The HDMI[1] input on your TV receives digital audio and
uncompressed digital video from an HDMI device or
uncompressed digital video from a DVI[2] device.
This input is designed to accept HDCP[3] program material in
digital form from EIA/CEA-861/861B–compliant[4] consumer
electronic devices (such as a set-top box or DVD player with
HDMI or DVI output).
__________________________________________________________________
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
HDMI = High-Definition Multimedia Interface.
DVI = Digital Video Interface.
HDCP = High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection.
EIA/CEA-861/861B compliance covers the transmission of
uncompressed digital video with high-bandwidth digital content
protection, which is being standardized for reception of high-definition
video signals. Because this is an evolving technology, it is possible that
some devices may not operate properly with the TV.
The HDMI input is designed for best performance with 720p
signals but will also accept and display 1080i, 480i, and 480p
signals.
Note: To ensure that the HDMI or DVI device is reset
properly, it is recommended that you follow these
procedures:
NOTE: NEVER CONNECT THIS TV TO A
PERSONAL COMPUTER (PC). THIS TV IS NOT
INTENDED FOR USE WITH A PC.
• When turning on your electronic components, turn on
the TV first, and then the HDMI or DVI device.
• When turning off your electronic components, turn off
the HDMI or DVI device first, and then the TV.
To connect an HDMI device, you will need:
• one HDMI cable (type A connector) per HDMI
device
To connect a DVI device, you will need:
For proper operation, it is recommended that you use as
short an HDMI cable as possible. You should not
encounter difficulty if you use an HDMI cable shorter than
16.4 ft (5m).
• one HDMI-to-DVI adapter cable (HDMI type A
connector) per DVI device
For proper operation, the length of an HDMI-to-DVI adapter
cable should not exceed 9.8 ft (3m). The recommended length is
6.6 ft (2m).
HDMI cable transfers both video and audio. Separate
analog audio cables are not required (see illustration
below). Some CDVs (video CDs) may not output digital
audio signals. In that case, you may hear sound by
connecting analog audio cables.
• one pair of standard analog audio cables per DVI
device
An HDMI-to-DVI adapter cable transfers video only.
Separate analog audio cables are required (see illustration
below).
See “Setting the HDMI audio mode” on page 50.
See “Setting the HDMI audio mode” on page 50.
HDMI device
DVI device
DVI/HDCP
OUT
HDMI OUT
VIDEO
AUDIO
VIDEO
AUDIO
R
IN
L
L
R
IN
L
L
OUT
R
OUT
R
TV
TV
___________
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface
are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting a digital audio system
Dolby Digital decoder or
other digital audio system
The TV’s DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal outputs a Dolby
Digital or 2-channel down-mixed PCM (pulse-code
modulation) signal for use with an external Dolby Digital
decoder or other external audio system with optical audio input.
Optical
Audio IN
LINE IN
L
R
You will need:
TV
ꢁ one optical audio cable (Use an optical audio cable that has
the larger “TosLink” connector and not the smaller
“mini-optical” connector.)
To control the audio:
Turn on the TV and the digital audio device.
Press MENU on the TV’s
remote control and open
Audio
the AUDIO menu.
Audio Settings
Advanced Audio Settings
Highlight Audio Setup and
Audio Setup
press ENTER.
In the Optical Output Format field, select either Dolby Digital
or PCM, depending on your device (see “Selecting the optical
audio output format” on page 86).
Note:
• Some audio systems may not be compatible with Dolby Digital bitstream
signals. Older audio systems that are not compatible with standard
optical out signals may not work properly, creating a high noise level
that may damage speakers or headphones. THIS DAMAGE IS NOT
COVERED BY YOUR WARRANTY.
Audio Setup
MTS
Stereo
English
Language
Speakers
On
• The DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal outputs signals only when receiving
digital broadcasts with the TV in single-window mode.
Optical Output Format
Dolby Digital
Reset
Done
• The DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal may not output some digital audio
sources because of copy restrictions.
Turn off the TV’s built-in speakers in the same Audio Setup
menu (above). Also see “Turning off the built-in speakers” on
page 86.
Connecting an analog audio system
This connection allows you to use external speakers with an
external audio amplifier to adjust the sound level.
Analog audio amplifier
LINE IN
You will need:
L
R
ꢁ one pair of standard audio cables
To control the audio:
TV
Turn on the TV and the stereo amplifier.
Turn off the TV’s built-in speakers (see “Turning off the built-in
speakers” on page 86).
Note: To hear sound when using an external audio amplifier,
the volume of both the TV and the amplifier must be set to a
reasonable listening level.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Controlling infrared remote-controlled devices through the TV (IR pass-through)
Front of IR-controlled DVD player (for example)
You can use the TV’s IR OUT terminal (infrared pass-through)
to remotely operate (through the TV) many infrared remote-
controlled devices (such as a Toshiba infrared remote-controlled
VCR or DVD player) enclosed within an entertainment center
or similar cabinet. Without the IR OUT connection, the device
typically would need to be visible to operate it remotely.
Front of IR-controlled audio device (for example)
You will need:
ꢁ one dual-wand IR blaster cable (included with your TV)
Infrared
sensor
ꢁ other audio/video cables as required to connect the device(s)
to the TV (see pages 13–20)
To connect the IR blaster cable:
IR blaster cable wand
(approx. 1 inch from device)
Back of TV
1. Locate the infrared sensor on the front of your device. This
sensor is marked on some devices.*
2. Align one of the IR blaster cable’s wands about 1 inch away
from the infrared sensor on the front of the device and
attach it using double-sided mounting tape. If you have a
second device, attach the second wand in a similar manner.
(See illustration at right.)
Note: If you do not have a second device, coil the second wand
with a rubber band and leave it behind the TV.
3. Plug the IR blaster cable’s plug into one of the TV’s
TheaterNet OUT terminals.
To control the device(s):
Point the TV remote control
(programmed to operate the device;
see Chapter 3) or the device’s remote
control at the front of the TV and
press the button for the desired
function. The signal passes from the
remote control through the TV to the
device via the IR blaster cable.
Using the TheaterNet IN:
Connect a device(DVD,etc) to TheaterNet IN on the back of the TV to
allow IR signals to control the TV.
See the instructions of the device for details.
TheaterNet™ on-screen device control
For additional control options for
your home theater system, set up
the TheaterNet on-screen device
control feature. You can use this
feature to control many IR remote-
controlled devices and IEEE1394
devices using the on-screen control
icons.
Note:
• If you use the device’s remote control to
operate the device, you also will need to
use the TV’s remote control to operate the TV.
• For additional control options, see “TheaterNet on-screen device
control” at right.
Toshiba
Video 3
ENTER
TOP MENU
EXIT
*
If you cannot locate the device’s infrared sensor:
1. Turn OFF the device.
2. Starting at the lower left corner of the device, place the end of the
device’s remote control (with the infrared emitter) so it touches the
front of the device and press POWER. (Do not use the TV’s remote
control for this step.)
3. If the device turns on, the point at which the remote control touched
the device is the location of the sensor.
See pages 45–49 for details on setting up
and using TheaterNet.
See pages 22–24 for details on
connecting IEEE1394 devices.
Note: The TheaterNet on-screen icons are the only device functions
available when the icons are on-screen. To access other device
functions, close the TheaterNet icon window.
4. If the device does not turn on, move the remote control slightly to the
right and press POWER again.
5. Repeat step 4 until you locate the device’s infrared sensor.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting IEEE1394 video devices
You can use the two bi-directional IEEE1394 ports on the back
of your TV to connect digital video devices that meet CEA
specifications for IEEE1394.
Supported signals
The IEEE1394 ports support only the signals listed below. Even
though incompatible video, audio, and digital control signals
cannot be decoded by the TV, these signals may be passed
through the IEEE1394 cable to other compatible devices.
Incompatible devices may not appear in the TheaterNet™ menu.
Because these ports are bi-directional, they can be used for both
playback and recording.
• Because IEEE1394 is an evolving technology, it is possible that some
or all of the connectivity features of a device you connect to the TV
through the IEEE1394 ports may not operate. You should confirm
that the devices you want to use with the IEEE1394 ports will operate
with those ports.
• This TV does not support all possible IEEE1394 signal types. For
information on signals supported by the IEEE1394 ports, see
“Supported signals” at right.
• MPEG-2 digital video signals
Other digital video signals—such as DV video—are
incompatible and must be decoded by the source device and
sent to the TV as analog video (composite or S-video).
• Dolby Digital and MPEG digital audio signals
Other digital audio signals (such as DPM, MP3, and DTS) are
incompatible and cannot be decoded by the TV.
• IEEE1394 cable carries both audio and video information;
separate audio cables are not required.
• EIA-775 and AV/C digital control
You will need:
ꢁ one (or two) IEEE1394 cables
Your TV can serve as the control center for many devices
that are compatible with EIA-775 or AV/C IEEE1394
control standards (described below).
Note: The transmission capability of IEEE1394 cable used with this
TV must be S400 (400 Mbps maximum).
The TV cannot control IEEE1394 devices that use any other
control standards.
ꢁ additional A/V cables if your device is analog-compatible
(see “Using analog-compatible IEEE1394 devices” below).
– EIA-775 digital control allows tuning devices (such as
Cable boxes) to send simple graphics; however, this
standard does not allow the TV to control the Cable box
through IEEE1394.
TV back panel
– AV/C (audio/video control) provides basic control (such
as power, play, stop rewind, fast-forward, pause, and
record), as applicable to the specific device.
Using TheaterNet™ on-screen device
control
You can use the TheaterNet feature to control some IEEE1394
devices using on-screen control icons. See page 45 for details on
setting up and using the TheaterNet feature.
}
Two bi-directional
IEEE1394 ports
From IEEE1394
Note: If the TheaterNet feature does not control your
IEEE1394 device, you can either use the device’s remote
control or try using IR pass-through with the TV’s remote
control (page 21).
devices (such as
AVHD or D-VHS)
Using analog-compatible IEEE1394 devices
Some digital IEEE1394 devices are compatible with analog
signals. For example, some D-VHS VCRs can record and play
VHS or S-VHS format videos. Such devices allow you to play
analog tapes that you rented or recorded, or record analog
programs from antenna or Cable TV systems. To use the
IEEE1394 device’s analog features, you need to connect the
device to the TV using standard A/V cables (or S-video plus
audio cables) in addition to connecting the IEEE1394 cable.
Note: If you have an IEEE1394 device connected to both digital
and analog inputs on the TV, the TV automatically switches
between digital and analog modes, as needed, when the initial
device access is initiated using the TheaterNet button.
See page 45 for details on using the TheaterNet feature.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting IEEE1394 video devices (continued)
Connecting an AVHD (external hard
drive) or D-VHS digital recorder
IEEE1394 device initialization
When you connect a new IEEE1394 device to the TV and turn
it on, the device immediately announces its presence to the TV
(and other networked IEEE1394 devices, if any), and the
following device initialization screen automatically appears.
You can connect an IEEE1394 compatible D-VHS or AVHD
(audio/video hard drive) digital recorder (such as Toshiba’s
Symbio™ AVHD Recorder) to record high definition and
standard definition material from either tuner and control live
TV (pause, rewind, etc.).
Note: With some devices, it may take up to one minute for this
screen to appear.
1. If you also connected your IEEE1394 device to an analog
input, use the yzx • buttons to select the input in the
ANALOG INPUT USED field; otherwise, leave it set to
“None.” (See “Using analog-compatible IEEE1394 devices”
on page 22.)
When you connect a D-VHS or AVHD device to the TV:
• The remote control keys (LIVE, REW, PAUSE, PLAY, FF, etc.) are
automatically activated to allow control of live TV.
• The TV Guide On Screen™ system is automatically configured to
allow recording to the device.* See Chapters 5 and 7 for details.
Also see page 50 for details on setting the AVHD device skip time.
2. If you want to label the device, highlight Edit Label and
press ENTER.
• Some programs may not be recorded due to copy protection
restrictions.
New IEEE1394 Device Initilization
Manufacturer
Device Type
Custom Label
TOSHIBA
AVHD
This TV is compatible with the new Toshiba
TM
Edit Label
Done
3. Press the yzx • buttons to select a character for the first
Audio/Video Hard Drive Recorder!
Toshiba’s Symbio™ AVHD Recorder is designed specifically for
high definition television (HDTV) and offers control over digital
video recording and playback.
space and then press ENTER.
4. Repeat step 3 to enter the rest of the characters.
5. Highlight Done and press ENTER to save the information.
Think of it as a “tapeless VCR” for digital television. You can pause,
rewind, or use instant replay, so you’ll never miss a thing!
IEEE1394 Device Label Edit
M Y D E V I C E _
Symbio also offers one-touch recording* of both standard and
High Definition programs through the no-fee TV Guide
On Screen™ interactive program guide built in to this TV.
A
H
O
V
2
B
I
C
J
D
K
R
Y
5
E
L
S
Z
6
F
M
T
0
G
N
U
1
P
W
3
Q
X
4
7
8
9
SPC
CLR
BS
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject
you to civil and criminal liability.
Cancel
Done
Note:
*Note: To enjoy the full benefits of your Symbio AVHD Recorder, you must
first set up the TV Guide On Screen™ system (see Chapter 5). Full Symbio
AVHD Recorder benefits, including Intelligent One Touch recording, will not
be available unless the TV Guide On Screen™ system is fully operational.
Even if the TV Guide On Screen™ system is not fully operational, however,
manual recording is available as long as the TV Guide On Screen™ system
has acquired the necessary date and time data. If you experience any issues
with your Symbio AVHD Recorder, please contact the following:
• The TV may not recognize incompatible or non-A/V IEEE1394
devices; however, these devices may still be available to other
compatible IEEE1394 devices on the network.
• You may be able to use the TV’s remote control to operate some
compatible IEEE1394 devices. You must first program the
remote control to recognize the device (see Chapter 3). If you
have an IEEE1394 Cable box or satellite receiver, you may need
to use the remote control that came with the device.
• In the U.S., call TACP Consumer Solutions at (800) 631-3811 or visit
http://www.tacp.com/customersupport/contact.asp.
• In Canada, call TCL Customer Service at 1-800-268-3404.
• Toshiba is not liable for the operation of any IEEE1394 device
other than the Toshiba Symbio AVHD recorder.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting IEEE1394 video devices (continued)
IEEE1394 device management
Important information regarding IEEE1394
device interconnection
The IEEE1394 device information is saved in the TV’s memory.
You can edit this device information (for example, edit the
device name, change the analog input information, or delete the
device information from the TV’s memory if you no longer use
that device).
• Never loop the last device in the chain back to the TV.
If the device chain is looped, the TV may not work properly with the
other devices in the chain.
• Always place devices with the slowest communication
speed at the end of each chain. If a device with a slower
communication speed is placed ahead of a faster device in the
chain, the signal from the slower device will interfere with the signal
from the faster device. To determine the communication speed of
an IEEE1394 device, look for an “S” number near the device’s
IEEE1394 connector. The higher the “S” number, the faster the
device. If your device is not marked with an “S” number, look in the
device’s user manual or call the device manufacturer’s technical
support number.
To edit the IEEE1394 device information:
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown in
step 3 below).
Setup
• If your IEEE1394 device has a two-position power
switch, always place the device at the end of the chain
and turn ON the power switch when any device is used.
If the power switch is OFF, it will interfere with signals from devices
behind it in the chain.
Installation
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
HDMI 1 Audio
Auto
Auto
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
2 Sec
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
• The maximum length for an IEEE1394 cable between
each device is 15 feet.
3. Open the Devices menu, highlight IEEE1394 Devices, and
press ENTER.
• This TV is an IEEE1394A device. The IEEE1394B protocol is faster
and intended to allow for longer distances between devices and
multi-room systems. IEEE1394A–to–IEEE1394B converters
(available at some electronics suppliers) may allow compatibility of
IEEE1394B devices with your existing IEEE1394A devices.
Devices
IEEE1394 Devices
• The transmission capability of IEEE1394 cable used with this TV
must be S400 (400 Mbps maximum).
TheaterNet Devices
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
4. Highlight the device you want to edit and press ENTER.
IEEE1394 Device Management
Brand
Type
Label
Analog Input Used Connected
No
TOSHIBA
AVHD MY DEVICE None
Reset
Done
5. Follow the on-screen prompts to modify the device
information.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
G-LINK™ connection
• This connection is necessary for the TV Guide On Screen™ system to work with your cable box to receive program listings and to
enable the TV Guide On Screen™ recording features with your VCR.
• This connection is not necessary for AVHD or D-VHS recording devices. See pages 23 and 50 for further details.
After you connect your devices to the TV, you will need to connect the G-LINK™ cable (either of the dual-wand IR blaster cables
included with your TV) from your VCR and Cable box (if applicable) to the G-LINK™ terminal on the TV.
Note: TV Guide On Screen™ program data is available through the ANT-1 and ANT-2 antenna inputs and also through the VIDEO 1 inputs if you
have a cable box connected to VIDEO 1. TV Guide On Screen™ program data is not available through any other inputs on this TV. See the
connection information on pages 13–25.
The G-LINK™ connection is necessary to enable the following features of your TV Guide On Screen™ system:
• If you have a Cable box, you need to connect the G-LINK™ cable from the Cable box to the G-LINK™ terminal to receive the
TV Guide On Screen™ program listings for your Cable service.
• If you have a VCR, you need to connect the G-LINK™ cable from the VCR to the G-LINK™ terminal to use the TV Guide
On Screen™ recording features.
To connect to the G-LINK™ terminal:
Front of Cable box
1. Locate the infrared sensor on the front of your VCR or
Cable box. The sensor is marked on some devices.*
2. Align one of the G-LINK™ (IR blaster) cable’s wands about
1 inch away from the infrared sensor on the front of the
VCR and attach it using double-sided mounting tape.
Front of VCR
If you have a Cable box, attach the other wand in a similar
manner. (See illustration at right.)
Note: If you do not have a Cable box, coil the second wand
with a rubber band and leave it behind the TV.
Infrared
3. Plug the G-LINK™ (IR blaster) cable’s plug into the TV’s
sensor
G-LINK™ terminal.
G-LINK™ (IR blaster) cable wand
(approx. 1 inch from device)
For details on setting up the TV Guide On Screen™ system:
Back of TV
See Chapter 5.
For details on using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive
program guide:
See Chapter 7.
*
If you cannot locate the device’s infrared sensor:
1. Turn OFF the device.
2. Starting at the lower left corner of the device, place the end of the
device’s remote control (with the infrared emitter) so it touches the
front of the device and press POWER. (Do not use the TV’s remote
control for this step.)
3. If the device turns on, the point at which the remote control touched
the device is the location of the sensor.
4. If the device does not turn on, move the remote control slightly to the
right and press POWER again.
5. Repeat step 4 until you locate the device’s infrared sensor.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
28
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting a personal computer (PC)
TV
This connection allows you to view the image of a personal
computer (PC) on the TV screen. When connecting a PC
to the TV, use an analog RGB (15-pin) computer cable and
a PC audio cable.
– To use a PC, set the monitor output resolution on the
PC before connecting it to the TV. The following signals
can be displayed.
• VGA: 640 × 480 @ 60Hz
• SVGA: 800 × 600 @ 60Hz
• XGA: 1024 × 768 @ 60Hz
Other formats or non-standard signals may not be
displayed correctly.
Computer
Audio cable
– To display the optimum picture, use the PC setting
feature. (see “Using the PC setting feature” on page 95).
Audio
output
Signal names for mini D-sub 15 pin
connector
Pin assignment for RGB/PC
terminal
Conversion
adapter
(if necessary)
5
10
15
1
6
11
Note:
• Some PC models cannot be connected to this TV.
Pin No.
Signal name
• An adapter is not needed for computers with a DOS/V compatible mini
D-sub 15-pin terminal.
1
2
R
G
B
• Depending on the DVD’s title and the specifications of the PC on which
you are playing the DVD-Video, some scenes may be skipped or you
may not be able to pause during multi-angle scenes.
3
4
NC (not connected)
NC
5
6
Ground
Ground
Ground
NC
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
Ground
NC
NC
H-sync
V-sync
NC
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV
Connecting a home network
Networking the TV with your home Internet e-mail service to enable remote
scheduling of recordings and reminders
You can network the TV with your home Internet service to remotely schedule recordings and reminders by sending an e-mail to the
TV.
To use this feature, you must have Internet e-mail service in your home and two separate e-mail addresses (your personal e-mail
address and a second e-mail address for use solely by the TV). Contact your ISP (Internet Service Provider) for these services.
Note:
• This feature is only for remotely scheduling recordings and reminders. You will not be able to access the Internet through the TV.
• To configure your TV for remote scheduling, see Chapter 11
Example #1: Networking via DSL modem service
Example #2: Networking via cable modem service
You will need:
You will need:
ꢁ three telephone cables
ꢁ three RJ-45 cables
ꢁ one telephone cable splitter
ꢁ one RJ-45 router
ꢁ one DSL modem
ꢁ three coaxial cables
ꢁ three RJ-45 cables
ꢁ one coaxial cable splitter
ꢁ one RJ-45 router
ꢁ one cable modem
Coaxial cable splitter
[3]
[3]
[1]
Telephone cable splitter
[1]
To TV (ANT IN or via
Cable Box or VCR)
Phone jack
[1]
To telephone
Coaxial cable jack
[3]
TV
Cable modem
Router
[2]
DSL modem
Router
[2]
[2]
[2]
PC
PC
[2]
[2]
[1] Telephone cable
[2] RJ-45 cable
[3] Coaxial cable
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
30
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the remote control
3
Learning about the remote control
The buttons used for operating the TV only are described here. For a
complete list of the remote control’s functions, see the remote control
functional key chart on pages 29–30.
For a list of the buttons that operate the TV Guide On Screen™ system, see
page 54.
POWER turns the TV on and off. Press POWER to turn on the TV. The blue
LED indicator on the TV front will be illuminated. Press POWER again to
turn off the TV.
Note: The Quick Restart setting will affect the amount of time it takes for the
picture to appear when you turn on the TV. See page 51 for details.
SLEEP accesses the sleep timer (page 94).
LIGHT The first press of the LIGHT button lights the keypad and turns on
the Illumination mode. With the Illumination mode on, pressing any key
lights the keypad for 5 seconds (10 seconds if you’re in programming
mode). Subsequent presses of the LIGHT button toggle between turning
the Illumination mode on and off.
Channel Numbers (0–9, –/100) directly tune channels. The “–” button is used
to tune digital channels (page 71) or to display the favorite channel list
(page 44).
INPUT selects the video input source (page 67).
MODE cycles through the six remote control device modes: TV, CBL/SAT,
VCR/PVR, DVD, AUDIO1, and AUDIO2. The mode indicator light will
remain lit for a few seconds (page 28).
PIC SIZE cycles through the five pictures sizes: Natural, TheaterWide 1/2/3,
and Full (page 72).
TheaterNet™ DEVICE displays a list of available TheaterNet devices (page 45).
TheaterNet™ CTRL accesses the on-screen IR device control icons (page 46).
MENU accesses the main TV menu system (pages 35 and 36) or opens a
menu in the TV Guide On Screen™ system (Chapter 7).
TV GUIDE opens the TV Guide On Screen™ system (Chapter 7).
INFO provides detailed information on highlighted items in the TV Guide
On Screen™ system (Chapter 7).
ENTER activates highlighted items in the main menu system and the
TV Guide On Screen™ system.
Arrow buttons (yz x •) When a menu is on-screen, these buttons select or
adjust programming menus. (Also see
x /
• on the next page.)
CH yz cycles through programmed channels when no menu is on-screen (42)
and functions as page up/down when a menu is on-screen or when the
TV Guide On Screen™ system is open (Chapter 7).
Note: The error message “Not
Available” will appear if you press a
key for a function that is not available
(Continued on next page)
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 3: Using the remote control
Learning about the remote control (continued)
VOL yz adjusts the volume level.
EXIT closes on-screen menus and the TV Guide On Screen® system.
CH RTN returns to the last viewed channel (page 71), or stops the picture viewer slide show
(page 88).
Live returns viewing of the TV back to the live program, while continuing to record to the Toshiba
Symbio™ AVHD recorder (pages 23 and 50).
RECALL displays TV setting information on-screen (page 92).
MUTE reduces or turns off the sound (page 84).
TV/VCR selects TV mode to view one program while recording another.
SKIP SS and TT jump forward and backward one day in the TV Guide On Screen™ listings
|
|
(Chapter 7).
LIST displays the Toshiba Symbio™ AVHD recorder play list (if available) (page 23).
FAV CH yz tunes to the next higher/lower favorite channel (page 44).
HOME (
)
accesses the home function of the channel browser feature (page 69)
x /
•
While watching TV, these buttons open the channel browser banner and tune to the
previous/next channel in the channel history (page 69). (Also see “Arrow buttons” on previous
page.)
SPLIT turns the POP feature on and off (page 76) or locks/unlocks the TV Guide On Screen™
video window.
PIC MODE selects the picture mode (page 79).
Remote control effective range
FAV SCAN accesses the favorite channel search function (page 78).
For optimum performance, aim the remote
control directly at the TV and make sure
there is no obstruction between the
remote control and the TV.
FREEZE accesses the freeze feature (page 78).
Point remote control
toward remote sensor
on front of TV.
16.4 ft (5m)
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
32
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 3: Using the remote control
Installing the remote control batteries
To install the remote control batteries:
Caution:
Never throw batteries into a fire.
Caution: Always dispose of batteries in a designated disposal location. Never
throw batteries into a fire.
Note:
1. Slide the battery cover off the back of the remote control.
• Be sure to use AA size batteries.
• Dispose of batteries in a designated disposal area.
• Batteries should always be disposed of with the
environment in mind. Always dispose of batteries in
accordance with applicable laws and regulations.
• If the remote control does not operate correctly, or if the
operating range becomes reduced, replace batteries
with new ones.
2. Install two “AA” size alkaline batteries. Match the + and – symbols on
the batteries to the symbols on the battery compartment.
• When necessary to replace batteries in the remote
control, always replace both batteries with new ones.
Never mix battery types or use new and used batteries in
combination.
• Always remove batteries from remote control if they are
dead or if the remote control is not to be used for an
extended period of time. This will prevent battery acid
from leaking into the battery compartment.
3. Slide the battery cover on to the remote control until the lock snaps.
Using the remote control MODE button to control your other devices
Your TV remote control has one dedicated TV mode and five programmable
multi-brand modes: CBL/SAT, VCR/PVR, DVD, AUDIO 1, and AUDIO 2. The
default device modes and programmable device modes are listed below.
Note: The TV remote control is preprogrammed to operate most Toshiba devices. If
you own a non-Toshiba device or a Toshiba device that the remote control is not
preprogrammed to operate, you will need to program the remote control. See
“Programming the remote control to operate your other devices” on page 31.
Number (1-6)
MODE
MODE
1) TV
Default device mode control (before programming)
Toshiba TV
2) CBL/SAT Toshiba Satellite receiver
3) VCR/PVR Toshiba VCR
4) DVD
Toshiba DVD
5) AUDIO 1 Pioneer Audio receiver
6) AUDIO 2 Pioneer LD
MODE
1) TV
Device mode control after programming
Toshiba TV
Note:
Although your new TV’s remote control includes
codes for many devices, it may not include
codes for some or all of the features on certain
devices you wish to control. If you are unable to
program the TV’s remote control to operate
your device or some of the features on that
device, use the device’s remote control or the
controls on the device.
2) CBL/SAT
3) VCR/PVR
4) DVD
Multi-brand video/audio devices
5) AUDIO 1
6) AUDIO 2
You can directly select the device mode by pressing the corresponding
number button (1-6) while pressing the MODE button.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 3: Using the remote control
Remote Control functional key chart
Toshiba TV
(TV)
Cable
Satellite
VCR
DVD/LD
Receiver
(AUDIO)
CD
(AUDIO)
PVR
(VCR)
Key Label
MODE
(CBL/SAT) (CBL/SAT)
Remote control device mode selection
Lights the remote key, and toggles between enabled and disabled Illumination mode.*1
LIGHT
SLEEP
Sleep timer ---
---
---
---
---
---
Power
---
POWER
Power
Power
Power
Power
Digit 1
Digit 2
Digit 3
Digit 4
Digit 5
Digit 6
Digit 7
Digit 8
Digit 9
Digit 0
100
Power
Digit 1
Digit 2
Digit 3
Digit 4
Digit 5
Digit 6
Digit 7
Digit 8
Digit 9
Digit 0
+10
Power
Power
1
Digit 1
Digit 2
Digit 3
Digit 4
Digit 5
Digit 6
Digit 7
Digit 8
Digit 9
Digit 0
Digit 1
Digit 2
Digit 3
Digit 4
Digit 5
Digit 6
Digit 7
Digit 8
Digit 9
Digit 0
---
Digit 1
Digit 2
Digit 3
Digit 4
Digit 5
Digit 6
Digit 7
Digit 8
Digit 9
Digit 0
AV input 1 Digit 1
AV input 2 Digit 2
AV input 3 Digit 3
AV input 4 Digit 4
Digit 1
Digit 2
Digit 3
Digit 4
Digit 5
Digit 6
Digit 7
Digit 8
Digit 9
2
3
4
5
CD
Digit 5
Digit 6
Digit 7
Digit 8
Digit 9
6
Tuner
Phono
Cassette
Aux
7
8
9
0
---
Digit 0, 10 Digit 0
100/–
– (digital
– (sub
---
---
---
- separator)
channel)
INPUT
TV/Video
select
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
PIC SIZE
Selects the
TV
image shape.
MENU/
ACTION
Menu/
Guide Menu
---
Action,
Menu
---
Menu
---
---
Menu
TV GUIDE/SETUP TV Guide ---
INFO/TITLE Guide Info ---
Guide
INFO
---
---
DVD setup ---
---
---
Guide
INFO
TITLE=
Top menu
---
---
---
---
TheaterNet
TheaterNet ---
---
---
---
---
Subtitle
Audio
Enter
---
---
ADVANCE
---
DEVICE/SUBTITLE Device
TheaterNet
CTRL/AUDIO
TheaterNet ---
Control
ENTER
Enter
---
Enter, Select ---
---
---
Enter
y
Menu select ---
up
Menu select ---
up
Menu select ---
up
Menu select
up
z
Menu select ---
down
Menu select ---
down
Menu select ---
down
---
---
---
---
Menu select
down
x •
Menu select ---
left/right
Menu select ---
left/right
Menu select ---
left/right
Menu select
left/right
EXIT/
DVD CLEAR
Exit
---
Exit
---
DVD clear ---
EXIT
CH yz
PAGE +/–
Channel
Channel
Channel
up/down
Channel
up/down
---
Channel
up/down
Channel
up/down
up/down, up/down
Page up/down
VOL yz
Volume
Volume
Volume
Volume
Volume
Volume
Volume
Volume
up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2
CH RTN/
DVD RTN
Previous
channel
Previous
channel
Previous
channel
---
DVD
return
---
---
---
Live
Live
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Live TV
---
RECALL
On-screen ---
display
On-screen ---
display
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
34
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 3: Using the remote control
Remote Control functional key chart (continued)
Toshiba TV
(TV)
Cable
Satellite
VCR
DVD/LD
Receiver
(AUDIO)
CD
(AUDIO)
PVR
(VCR)
Key Label
MUTE
(CBL/SAT) (CBL/SAT)
Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2
SLOW
x
•
Slow FWD Slow FWD
Slow FWD
---
------
------
------
------
------
------
------
------
---
Slow REW
SKIP
x Skip FWD
• Skip REW
Skip FWD
Skip REW
Skip FWD
Skip REW
------
------
REW
Rewind
---
---
---
---
Rewind
Pause
Play
Rewind
Pause
Play
---
---
---
Rewind
Pause
Play
Rewind
Pause
Play
PAUSE/STEP Pause
---
PLAY
FF
Play
---
Fast FWD ---
---
Fast FWD Fast FWD ---
Fast FWD Fast FWD
TV/VCR
---
---
---
---
TV/SAT
---
TV/VCR
---
---
---
---
Reverse
Replay
Stop
DISC/AM/FM ---
Disc shift
Stop
---
AM/FM
---
Disc shift
Stop
---
STOP
REC
Stop
---
Stop
REC Menu ---
(Single Click)
---
Record
(Double Click)
---
Record
(Double Click)
LIST
LIST
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
FAV CH yz
FAV channel ---
up/down
HOME
HOME
Split
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
SPLIT
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
---
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
---
PIC MODE
FAV SCAN
FREEZE
PIC MODE
TV
TV
TV
TV
FAV SCAN ---
Freeze
---
---
---
---
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
TV
Notes:
• “---” = key does not send a signal.
• “ TV” = key will operate the TV.
*1 Backlight key is toggle. Does not send IR signal.
*2 Volume will punch through to TV by default. When the volume is unlocked, all the devices will have their own volume if their ID has
volume data. The AUDIO modes (receiver, CD) will have their own volume if volume lock is done to TV, CBL/SAT, VCR/PVR, or DVD
mode. See “Using the volume lock feature” on page 32.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 3: Using the remote control
Programming the remote control to operate your other devices
Device code setup
1. Refer to the multi-brand remote control device code table
on pages 33–34 to find the code for the brand of your
device.
Searching and sampling the code of
a device (8500)
If you do not know the device code for a particular device, you
can cycle the remote control through the available codes for that
device mode and sample the functions to find the code that
operates the target device. The keys available to be sampled,
provided they are applicable to that mode, are POWER, 1,
VOL y, CH y, and PLAY. Invalid keys will be ignored while in
program mode.
If more than one code is listed, try each one separately until
you find one that works.
2. Press MODE until the Mode indicator for the device
(CBL/SAT, VCR/PVR, DVD, AUDIO 1, AUDIO 2) lights
up.
3. While holding down the RECALL button, press the
Channel Number buttons to enter the four-digit code for
your brand of device. If a valid code is entered, the mode
indicator will blink twice. If an invalid code is entered, the
mode indicator will blink one long blink.
To cycle through each available device code and sample its
functions:
1. Press MODE to select the mode you want to set up.
2. While holding down RECALL, press 8 – 5 – 0 – 0. The
remote control will enter program mode.
4. Point the remote control at the device and press POWER to
test the code.
3. Point the remote control at the target device and press
POWER (or other function buttons that are available to be
sampled).
If the device responds to the remote control:
You have entered the correct code.
If the device does not respond to the remote control:
You may have entered the wrong code. Repeat steps 3
and 4 using another code.
Note: In addition to POWER, confirm that all necessary keys
on the TV remote control operate your device. If some keys
are not operational, repeat the device code setup using
another code (if other codes are listed for your device). If,
after trying all listed codes, the necessary keys do not operate
your device, use the device’s original remote control.
4. If the device responds to the remote control:
Press RECALL to store the device code. The mode
indicator will blink twice and the remote control will exit
the program mode.
If the device does not respond to the remote control:
Press y, and then press POWER. Repeat this step until
the device responds to the remote control, and then press
RECALL.
Note: When a search cycle is completed, the mode
indicator will blink three times. The remote control will
begin to cycle through the available codes again. If no key
is pressed within 10 seconds while programming, the
remote control will exit the program mode and return to the
previous code.
5. To control the TV, repeatedly press MODE to select “TV.”
Note:
• Although the TV remote control includes codes for many devices, it may
not include codes for some or all of the features on certain devices you
want to control. If you are unable to program the TV remote control to
operate your device or some of the features on that device, use the
device’s remote control or the controls on the device.
POWER
• Each time you change the batteries you will need to reprogram the
remote control.
Numbers
MODE
• Some newer VCRs respond to either of two codes. These VCRs have a
switch labeled “VCR1/VCR2.” If your VCR has this kind of switch and
does not respond to the codes for your VCR brand, set the switch to the
other position (“VCR1” or “VCR2”) and reprogram the remote control.
y
CH y
VOL y
RECALL
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
36
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 3: Using the remote control
Programming the remote control to operate your other devices (continued)
Using the volume lock feature (8000) Operational feature reset (8900)
For the TV, CABLE/SAT, VCR, and DVD modes, the volume
controls (VOL yz and MUTE) can be locked to the selected
device mode. This feature does not apply to the AUDIO 1 and
AUDIO 2 modes.
This feature clears all programmed features not related to “Device
code setup” and resets the Volume Lock to “TV.”
To reset the features:
While holding down the RECALL button, press 8 –9 –0 – 0.
The Mode indicator will blink two times, and then pause
and blink two more times.
To lock the volume controls to always control the
CABLE/SAT device volume (for example):
1. Repeatedly press MODE to select CABLE/SAT mode.
2. While holding down the RECALL button, press 8 – 0 – 0 – 0.
3. Press VOL y.
The CABLE/SAT mode light will blink two times (locked).
To reset the volume controls to the original device mode:
1. While holding down RECALL, press 8 – 0 – 0 – 0.
2. Press VOL z.
Numbers
MODE
The mode light will blink four times (unlocked).
VOL yz
RECALL
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 3: Using the remote control
Multi-brand remote control device codes
VCRs/PVRs
Brand
VCRs/PVRs (cont.)
Brand
Cable boxes
Brand
Code
Code
Code
ADMIRAL
AIWA
AKAI
0135
PHILCO
PHILIPS
0131, 0124, 0127,
0123, 0126, 0120,
0143
0131, 0123, 0124,
0173
ABC
1124
0127, 0132, 0181
0129, 0114, 0115,
0116
0139, 0111
0105, 0113
0120, 0126, 0180
0123, 0125
0143
ARCHER
CABLEVIEW
CITIZEN
CURTIS
DIAMOND
EAGLE
EASTERN
GCBRAND
GEMINI
1132, 1125
1105, 1132
1122, 1105
1112, 1113
1124, 1132, 1125
1129
AUDIO DYNAMIC
BELL&HOWELL
BROKSONIC
CANON
CCE
CITIZEN
CRAIG
CURTIS MATHES
DAEWOO
PIONEER
PROSCAN
0123
0145, 0100, 0123,
0124, 0131, 0146,
0101, 0102, 0133
0121, 0122, 0123,
0124
0133, 0124, 0105,
0136, 0109, 0140,
0127
0133, 0145, 0100,
0123, 0124, 0131,
0146, 0101, 0102,
0170, 0172, 0174,
0176, 0183
1134
1132, 1105
1122, 1143
1119, 1124, 1125,
1126, 1127, 1120,
1121, 1122, 1111,
1123, 1152
1140, 1141, 1142,
1145, 1118, 1112
1103, 1124
1103, 1104, 1105,
1108
0106
QUASAR
0105, 0129, 0106
0145, 0124, 0127
0143, 0101, 0124,
0175
0139, 0110, 0111
0145
0143, 0126, 0119,
0103, 0125, 0142,
0120, 0118
G.I./JERROLD
RADIO SHACK
DBX
DIMENSIA
EMERSON
RCA
HAMLIN
HITACHI
MACOM
FISHER
FUNAI
0105, 0108, 0109,
0107, 0113, 0165
0127, 0126, 0120,
0134
0133, 0145, 0124
0137, 0151, 0163,
0149, 0150, 0182
0106
0170, 0171, 0168,
0134, 0156
0123, 0145, 0100,
0127, 0168
REALISTIC
0124, 0105, 0136,
0109, 0140, 0127
7102
0137, 0102, 0104,
0133
0163
0139, 0126, 0120,
0152
0105, 0109, 0113
0101, 0102, 0104,
0109, 0138, 0140,
0147, 0148, 0126
0105, 0106, 0107,
0108, 0100
0135, 0136, 0167,
0162
0117
0127, 0135
0117
0128, 0129, 0130,
0153, 0154, 0155,
7101
0127
0131, 0123, 0124,
0127, 0178
0127, 0168, 0177
0106
0139, 0110, 0111
0139, 0110, 0127,
0111
MAGNAVOX
MEMOREX
MOVIETIME
OAK
1133
1130
Replay TV
SAMSUNG
1132, 1105
1139, 1137, 1102
1109, 1110, 1114,
1151, 1153
1128, 1129, 1130,
1106, 1107, 1150,
1131
1101, 1116
1105, 1132
1132
1115
1132
1112, 1118, 1140,
1141, 1142, 1145,
1149
GE
GO VIDEO
PANASONIC
SAMTRON
SANSUI
PHILIPS
GOLDSTAR
GRADIENTE
SANYO
SCOTT
PIONEER
PULSAR
PUSER
RCA
REALISTIC
REGAL
HITACHI
INSTANT REPLAY
JENSEN
JVC
0124, 0123
0139
SEARS
SHARP
0139, 0110, 0111,
0134, 0157, 0158,
0184, 0185, 7104
0139, 0110, 0106,
0111
SHINTOM
SIGNATURE 2000
SINGER
KENWOOD
REGENCY
REMBRANT
1134
1137, 1132, 1105,
1138
LG
LXI
0159
SONY
0127, 0106, 0100,
0107, 0108, 0105,
0109
0131, 0123, 0124,
0173
0139, 0110, 0111
0106
0124, 0109
0138, 0140, 0147,
0148, 0141, 0142
0100, 0145
0138, 0140, 0147,
0148, 0141, 0142,
0161, 0164
0147, 0127, 0104
0139, 0110, 0111,
0134
SAMSUNG
S.A.
SLMARK
SPRUCER
STARGATE
TELECAPTION
TELEVIEW
TEXSCAN
TOCOM
TOSHIBA
UNIKA
UNIVERSAL
VIDEOWAY
VIEWSTAR
ZENITH
1105
1111, 1112, 1113
1105, 1101
1105, 1110
1132, 1105
1148
SV2000
SYLVANIA
MAGNAVOX
MARANTZ
MARTA
MEMOREX
MGA
SYMPHONIC
TASHIRO
TATUNG
TEAC
1101, 1105
1144
1135, 1136, 1147
1104, 1146
1132, 1125
1122, 1132
1106
1129, 1130
1117, 1100
1100
MINOLTA
MITSUBISHI
TECHNICS
0121, 0122, 0123,
0124
0124, 0127, 0112
0179, 0183
7100, 7101
0101, 0146, 0166,
0160
TEKNICA
THOMSON
Tivo
MULTITECH
NEC
TOSHIBA
ZENITH/DRAKE
SATELLITE
OLYMPIC
OPTIMUS
0124, 0123
0128, 0121, 0135,
0106
0126, 0120, 0132
0123, 0124, 0121,
0122
0124, 0100, 0145,
0105, 0139, 0110,
0111
VECTOR RESEARCH 0111
WARDS
0135, 0136, 0109,
0144, 0106
0105, 0139, 0110,
0111
0144, 0106, 0169,
0180
ORION
PANASONIC
YAMAHA
ZENITH
PENNEY
PENTAX
0100, 0111, 0145
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
38
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 3: Using the remote control
Multi-brand remote control device codes (continued)
Receivers (cont.)
Brand
DVD players
Brand
CD players
Brand
Code
Code
Code
ADMIRAL
AIWA
CARVER
DENON
EMERSON
FISHER
GARRARD
HARMAN/KARDON 6120, 6121, 6123,
6119
6126
6133, 6135
6129
6142, 6151
6139
6105, 6106
6117
PIONEER
QUASAR
RCA
4105, 4107, 4150
4119, 4118, 4121
4103, 4105, 4127,
4131, 4130, 4149
4103, 4111, 4139
4134, 4137
4122
4138
4112, 4113, 4111,
4110
4121, 4118, 4119
4132, 4133
AIWA
APEX
DENON
FERGUSON
HITACHI
JVC
KENWOOD
KONKA
MITSUBISHI
NORDMENDE
ONKYO
ORITRON
PANASONIC
PHILIPS
PIONEER
RAITE
3123
3120
3100, 3117
3101
3111
3109
3115, 3129
3119
3105
3101
3121
3124
3100
3103, 3116
3102
SANSUI
SHARP
SONY
SOUNDE-SIGH
TEAC
HITACHI
JENSEN
JVC
6107
6134
6140, 6141, 6145,
6148, 6151
6100, 6101, 6111,
6145
TECHNICS
VICTOR
YAMAHA
4101, 4102
KENWOOD
Laser disks
Brand
Code
LXI
6136
3113
MAGNAVOX
MARANTZ
MACINTOSH
NAKAMICHI
ONKYO
6129, 6132
6129
6121
RCA
SABA
SAMPO
SAMSUNG
SHARP
SYLVANIA
SMC
SONY
3101, 3106
3101
3114
3110
3108
3132, 3118
3125
3104, 3126, 3127,
3128
3100
3101
3103
3122
3100, 3130
3107, 3112
3131
DENON
HITACHI
5114
5100
5102, 5103
5101
5114
5114, 5118, 5119
5114
5104, 5105, 5106,
5115
5111
5114
5114
5104, 5105, 5106,
5115
5114
5112
5114, 5117
5113, 5116
5107, 5108, 5109,
5110
5114
5114
KENWOOD
MAGNAVOX
MARANTZ
MITSUBISHI
NEC
6110
6114, 6115
6108, 6118, 6120,
6122
6124, 6125, 6127,
6150
OPTIMUS
PANASONIC
PANASONIC
PHILIPS
PIONEER
QUASAR
RCA
6129, 6130, 6149
6108
TECHNICS
THOMSON
TOSHIBA
WAVE
YAMAHA
ZENITH
VIALTA
PHILIPS
PIONEER
PROSCAN
QUASAR
6125, 6127, 6124
6147, 6137, 6138,
6131, 6152
6110, 6146, 6113
6105
6110, 6146
6142, 6143
6120
6128
6144
6112, 6116, 6118
6127, 6124, 6125
6140, 6141, 6145
6102, 6103, 6104
SANSUI
SANYO
SCOTT
SHARP
SHERWOOD
SONY
SOUNDE-SIGH
TEAC
TECHNICS
VICTOR
YAMAHA
RCA
SAMSUNG
SANYO
SHARP
SONY
FUNAI
3132, 3118
Satellite receivers
Brand
DISH NETWORK
(Echostar)
ECHOSTAR
EXPRESS VU
G.E.
Code
2105, 2115, 2116,
2117
2105
2105, 2115
2106
TEAC
TOSHIBA
YAMAHA
5101
G.I.(GENERAL
INSTRUMENT)
GRADIENTE
HITACHI
HNS(Hughes)
MAGNAVOX
PANASONIC
PHILIPS
2108
Receivers
Brand
Code
2114
2103, 2111, 2112
2103
2101, 2102
2104
2101, 2102, 2118
2108
2106, 2109, 2110,
2113
2106, 2109, 2110,
2113
ADMIRAL
AIWA
DENON
4120
4125, 4126, 4146
4134, 4135, 4136,
4143
4104
4113
FISHER
GARRARD
HARMAN KARDON 4115, 4123, 4145
JENSEN
JVC
PRIMESTAR
PROSCAN
4129
4132, 4133, 4140,
4144
RCA
SONY
STAR CHOICE
TOSHIBA
2107
KENWOOD
4100, 4108, 4141,
4142, 4147
4127, 4128
4124
4116
4148
4106, 4117
4109, 4114
4103, 4127, 4131,
4130
2103, 2108
2100, 2103, 2119,
2120, 2121, 2122,
2123, 2124, 2125
2101, 2102
MAGNAVOX
MARANTZ
MCNTOSH
MITSUBISHI
NAKAMICHI
ONKYO
UNIDEN
OPTIMUS
PANASONIC
PHILIPS
4119, 4118, 4121
4123
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Menu layout and navigation
4
The illustrations below and on the next page provide a quick overview of your TV’s menu system.
Main menu layout
To open the main menus (illustrated below), press MENU on the remote control or TV control panel.
● TV Guide On Screen™ ● Launch Gemstar / TV GUIDE
● Audio Player ● Launch MP3 audio player
Applications ● Picture Viewer ● Launch the Picture viewer
● Digital CC / Audio Selector ● Launch the ATSC Digital CC Selector
● CableCARD™ ● Dynamic list of items provided by inserted CableCARD™.
(This option is not available if CableCARD™ is not inserted.)
● Picture Settings ● [ Picture Settings Edit Window ]
Video
● Advanced Picture Settings ● [ Advanced Picture Settings Edit Window ]
● Theater Settings ● [ Theater Settings Edit Window ]
● Audio Settings ● [ Audio Settings Window ]
Audio
● Advanced Audio Settings ● [ Advanced Audio Settings Window ]
● Audio Setup ● [ Audio Setup Window ]
● Favorite Channels ● [ Favorite Channels Edit Window ]
● Closed Caption Mode ● Off / CC1 / CC2 / CC3 / CC4 / T1 / T2 / T3 / T4
● Closed Caption Advanced ● [ Advanced Closed Captions Window ]
● Input Labeling ● [ Input Labeling Edit Window ]
Preferences
● Menu Language ● English / Français / Español
● Home CH Setup ● [ Home channel Setup Window ]
● Enable Rating Blocking ● Off / On
Locks
● Edit Rating Limits ● [ Edit Rating Limits Edit Window ]
● Channels Block ● [ Channels Block Edit Window ]
● Input Lock ● Off / Video / Video+
Applications
TV Guide On Screen
Audio Player
Picture Viewer
Digital CC/Audio Selector
CableCARD
● Front Panel Lock ● Off / On
● GameTimer™ ● Off / 30 Min / 60 Min / 90 Min / 120 Min
● New PIN Code ● [ New PIN Code Entry Window ]
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
When the TV is in these conditions
below, the background of the menu
picture will appear black.
● Installation ● [ Installation sub menu is launched (see page 36
for details) ]
● Sleep Timer ● [ Sleep Timer Edit Window ]
● On/Off Timer ● [ On/Off Timer window ]
● PC Settings ● [ PC Settings Edit Window ]
● HDMI 1 Audio ● Auto / Digital / Analog
● HDMI 2 Audio ● Auto / Digital / Analog
● Slide Show Interval ● 2 sec. / 5 sec. / 10 sec. / 15 sec. / 20 sec.
● AVHD Skip Time ● 1 min. / 3 min. / 5 min. / 15 min.
● Gray Level ● 1 / 2 / 3
• A 1080 signal is received.
• Input source is selected in
ColorStream HD1 or
ColorStream HD2.
Setup
● Quick Restart ● Off / On
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
40
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 4: Menu layout and navigation
Setup / Installation menu layout (continued)
To open the Installation menu (illustrated below), press MENU on the remote control or TV control panel, open the Setup menu,
select Installation, and press ENTER.
From Main Menu/Setup
menu, select “Installation”
sub-menu
● Input Configuration ● [ Input Configuration Window ]
●
Terrestrial
● Channel Program ● ANT1
● [ Scan for new channels on desired Antenna ]
}
● ANT2
● Channel Add/Delete ● [ Channel Add / Delete Window ]
● Signal Meter ● [ Signal Meter Window ]
● IEEE1394 Devices ● [ IEEE1394 Device Management Window ]
Devices
Network
● TheaterNet Devices ● [ TheaterNet Setup Window ]
● Basic Network setup
● Recording E-mail setup
● Home File server setup
TV Guide On Screen™ Setup ● Start ● [ Launches TV Guide On Screen™ system setup ]
Time and Date ● Start Setup ● [ Time And Date Setup Window ]
System Status ● System Information ● [ System Information Window ]
Navigating the menu system
You can use the buttons on the remote control or TV control
panel to access and navigate your TV’s on-screen menu system.
TV control panel
Remote control
• Press MENU to open the menu system.
• Use the up/down/left/right arrow buttons (yzx •) on the
remote control or TV control panel to move in the
corresponding direction in a menu.
MENU
(ENTER*)
y
• Press ENTER to save your menu settings or select a
highlighted item. (A highlighted menu item appears in a
different color in the menu.)
z
•
MENU
x
EXIT
• All menus close automatically if you do not make a
selection within 60 seconds, except the signal meter menu
which closes automatically after 5 minutes.
ENTER
y
*The MENU button on the TV
control panel functions as
the ENTER button when a
menu is on-screen.
x
•
• To close a menu instantly, press EXIT.
z
EXIT
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
TV Guide On Screen™ setup
5
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen™ system
The TV Guide On Screen™ system in your TV is a no-fee
Configuring the location of your TV
Screen 1: Select the TV location (USA or Canada), and then
interactive program guide that uses the information you enter
during the following setup process to provide you with a
channel lineup and program listings for your area. The listings
are automatically updated several times a day.
press ENTER.
Note:
• You must first set up your TV according to the applicable
connection instructions in Chapter 2.
TM
• If you connected a Toshiba
AVHD Recorder, you
must perform the following TV Guide On Screen™ system setup
in order to use the Symbio’s full functionality. See pages 23 and
50 for further details about AVHD digital recorders.
To set up the TV Guide On Screen™ system:
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER.
Screen 2: Enter the ZIP code (U.S.A.) or postal code (Canada)
for your location (use the Number buttons on the remote
control for numbers and the yz buttons for letters), and
then press ENTER. Screen 3 appears.
Setup
Installation
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
HDMI 1 Audio
Auto
Auto
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
2 Sec
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
3. A new set of Installation
menu icons appears
on-screen (see
Screen 3: Do you have Cable service connected?
If you select Yes (and press ENTER), screen 4 appears.
If you select No (and press ENTER), screen 12 appears.
TV Guide On Screen Setup
Start
illustration at right).
Open the TV Guide
On Screen™ Setup
menu, highlight Start,
and press ENTER.
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
4. The following screen appears. Highlight “Set up TV Guide
On Screen™ now” and press ENTER to continue.
Screen 4: Do you have a Cable box connected?
If you select Yes (and press ENTER), screen 5 appears.
If you select No (and press ENTER), screen 13 appears.
5. The following screen appears. Press ENTER to continue.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
42
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 5: TV Guide On Screen™ setup
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen™ system (continued)
Screen 5: Which TV input is your cable box plugged into?
If you select ANT 1, screen 6 appears.
Screen 9: To allow the TV Guide On Screen™ system to find
the correct code for your brand of Cable box, tune your
Cable box to channel 02, leave the Cable box and TV ON,
and then press ENTER. Screen 10 appears.
If you select Video 1, screen 7 appears.
Screen 6: Select the channel your TV is tuned to when using
Screen 10: The TV Guide On Screen™ system will test the code
for the brand of Cable box you selected. Do not press any
keys on the TV, remote control, or Cable box until the
testing process is completed. When testing is completed,
screen 11 appears.
your cable box, and then press ENTER. Screen 7 appears.
Screen 7: The on-screen diagram shows the correct way to
connect your Cable box to the G-LINK™ terminal on the
TV. Make sure the G-LINK™ cable is installed properly.
For additional details, see page 25.
Screen 11: If your Cable box tuned itself to channel 09 after
testing, select Yes and press ENTER. If you selected ANT 1
in screen 5, screen 13 appears. If you selected Video 1 in
screen 5, screen 12 appears.
Press ENTER to display screen 8.
Screen 8: Highlight your Cable box brand, and then press
ENTER to display screen 9.
If your Cable box did not tune itself to channel 09 after
testing and you want to test the same code again, select
“Test this code again” and press ENTER.
If you want to test a different code, select No and press
ENTER. Screen 10 appears.
Note: Many cable boxes require testing more than one code.
(Continued on next page)
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 5: TV Guide On Screen™ setup
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen™ system (continued)
Screen 12: Do you have an antenna connected?
Select either Yes or No, and then press ENTER. Screen 13
appears.
Screen 16: The on-screen diagram shows the correct way to
connect your VCR to the G-LINK™ terminal on the TV.
Make sure the G-LINK™ cable is installed properly. For
additional details, see page 25.
Note: If you selected NO in screen 3, you must select YES in
this screen to receive a channel lineup and program listings.
Press ENTER to display screen 17.
Screen 17: Select your VCR brand, and then press ENTER.
Screen 13: Are the settings correct?
If you select Yes, screen 14 appears.
If you select No, screen 1 appears.
Screen 18 appears.
Screen 18: Turn on your VCR, insert a tape (either blank or
previously recorded), and then press PLAY. Screen 19
appears.
Screen 14: Congratulations! You have completed basic
TV Guide On Screen™ system setup.
Note: Read the on-screen information regarding the amount
of time it may take for listing information to download from
the TV Guide On Screen™ service.
Press ENTER to display screen 15.
Screen 19: The TV Guide On Screen™ system will test the code
for the brand of VCR you selected. Do not press any keys
on the TV, remote control, or VCR until the testing process
is completed. When testing is completed, screen 20 appears.
Screen 15: Is a VCR connected?
If you select Yes, screen 16 appears.
If you select No, screen 21 appears.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
44
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 5: TV Guide On Screen™ setup
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen™ system (continued)
Screen 20: If your VCR stopped playing the tape after testing,
select Yes and press ENTER. Screen 21 appears.
TV Guide On Screen™ Reminder
If your VCR did not
stop playing the tape
after testing and you
want to test the same
code again, select
The TV Guide On Screen™ system receives program listing
data through your Cable or over-the-air video signal. In
order to receive regular program listing updates, remember
to do the following:
Did your VCR stop playing?
1. Leave the TV in standby mode when it is not in use
by turning it OFF but leaving the power cord
plugged in.
“Test this code again”
and press ENTER.
If you want to test a
different code, select No and press ENTER. Screen 19
appears.
2. If you have a Cable box connected, leave it ON.
3. If you have a VCR connected, turn it OFF when not
in use. (Do not unplug the power cord.) See page 13
for VCR connection instructions.
Note: Many VCRs require testing more than one code.
4. If you have more than one Cable system in your area,
you may be prompted to select which Cable system’s
program data to download. If so prompted, follow the
on-screen instructions.
Screen 21: Review the setup information displayed on your TV
screen (an example is shown below).
If the information on
your TV screen is
correct for your setup,
select “Yes, end setup”
and press ENTER.
Screen 22 appears.
Note: If the TV power cord is unplugged for an
extended period of time, it may take up to 24 hours with
the TV in standby mode (power cord plugged in and
power OFF) to download the TV Guide On Screen™
program schedule. It may take up to a week before an
entire program schedule is available.
If the information is
incorrect, select “No,
repeat setup process” and press ENTER. Screen 1 appears.
Turning off the TV Guide On Screen™
automatic display feature
Screen 22: Congratulations! You have successfully completed
TV Guide On Screen™ system setup.
After you set up the TV Guide On Screen™ system, the
program guide will display automatically (by default) when
you turn on the TV. To turn off the automatic program guide:
Press ENTER to
display screen 23.
1. Press TV GUIDE on the remote control to open the
TV Guide On Screen™ system (if it is not already open).
2. Use the x • buttons to select the Setup menu.
3. Use the yz buttons to select “Change Default
Options,” and then press ENTER.
4. Use the yz buttons to select “General Defaults,” and
Screen 23: This screen provides helpful information on using
then press ENTER.
your TV Guide On Screen™ system.
5. Set the “Auto Guide” option to Off.
6. Use the yz buttons to select Done, and then press
Press ENTER to exit
the TV Guide
ENTER.
On Screen™ setup and
watch TV.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setting up your TV
6
For menu navigation instructions, see Chapter 4.
Selecting the menu language
Configuring the antenna input
sources
You can choose from three different languages (English, French
and Spanish) for the on-screen display of menus and messages.
(The TV Guide On Screen™ menus are in English, regardless of
the language selected in this menu.)
To configure the ANT 1 and ANT 2 input sources:
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown in
step 3 below.)
To select the menu language:
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.
2. Highlight Menu Language and press •.
3. Press y or z to select your preferred menu language and
Setup
press ENTER.
Installation
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
Preferences
HDMI 1 Audio
Auto
Auto
English
Français
Español
Favorite Channels
Closed Caption Mode
HDMI 2 Audio
Off
Slide Show Interval
2 Sec
Closed Caption Advanced
Input Labeling
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Menu Language
English
Home CH Setup
3. Open the Terrestrial menu, highlight Input Configuration,
and press ENTER.
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Note: The Terrestrial menu may not be accessible (items will
be “grayed out”) in some instances (for example, if a cable
box is connected to the ANT 1 input or if one of the VIDEO
modes is the current input during TV Guide On Screen™
setup).
4. Press EXIT to close the Preferences menu.
Terrestrial
Input Configuration
Channel Program
Channel Add/Delete
Signal Meter
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
4. Press x or • to select the input source (Cable or Antenna)
for the ANT 1 input on the TV.
Note: If a cable box is connected to the ANT 1 input during
TV Guide On Screen™ setup, the entire Terrestrial menu will
not be accessible, including the input source for ANT 1, which
will automatically display “Cable Box.”
5. Press z and then x or • to select the input source (Cable
or antenna) for the ANT 2 input on the TV, if applicable. If
you have not connected anything to ANT 2, skip this step.
Input Configuration
Antenna 1 In
Cable
Antenna 2 In
Antenna
Cancel
Done
6. To save your new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to your original settings, highlight
Cancel and press ENTER.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
46
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV
Programming channels into the TV’s channel memory
When you press CHANNEL y or z on the remote control or
TV control panel, your TV will stop only on the channels stored
in the TV’s channel memory.
4. Open the Terrestrial menu, highlight Channel Program,
and press ENTER.
5. Highlight ANT 1 or
ANT 2, depending on
which antenna input
you want to program
channels for, and then
press ENTER to start
automatic channel
Follow the steps below to program channels into the TV’s
channel memory.
Terrestrial
Input Configuration
Channel Program
Channel Add/Delete
Signal Meter
Programming channels automatically
Your TV can automatically detect all active channels in your area
and store them in its memory. After the channels are
programmed automatically, you can manually add or erase
individual channels.
programming.
Navigate
ANT 1
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Antenna
Scanning channels, please wait ...
Note:
52%
Abort
• You must configure the antenna input sources before
programming channels (see page 41).
The TV will automatically cycle through all the channels
for the antenna input you selected, and store all active
channels in the channel memory. While the TV is cycling
through the channels, the message “Scanning channels,
please wait” appears (as shown above).
• If the input signal type is set to CABLE for an antenna input, the
automatic channel programming process erases channels that
were previously programmed into the TV’s memory.
• If the input signal type is set to ANTENNA, the automatic
channel programming process does NOT erase channels that
were previously programmed into the TV’s memory, but adds
newly found channels to the existing set of programmed
channels. To remove a channel from the memory, you must
manually delete it (see next page).
6. To cancel channel programming, either press EXIT or
highlight Abort in the on-screen display and press ENTER.
When channel programming is done, press CHANNEL
y or z to view the programmed channels.
• To tune the TV to a channel not programmed in the channel
memory, you must use the Channel Number buttons on the
remote control.
• Programming channels for an antenna input configured for
CABLE will take substantially longer than for an antenna input
configured for ANTENNA. This is normal; however, once
channel programming is completed, you should not have to
repeat the programming process again unless your Cable TV
service lineup changes significantly.
Channel
Numbers
• If you have a CableCARD™ inserted (page 12), channel
programming for ANT 1 is disabled because the CableCARD™
automatically loads the Cable channel list into the TV’s channel
memory.
To program channels automatically:
1. Make sure you have configured the antenna input sources.
See page 41 for details.
TV control panel
2. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
CHANNEL yz
3. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen).
MENU
(ENTER)
Setup
CHANNEL
/
Installation
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
HDMI 1 Audio
Auto
Auto
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
2 Sec
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV
Programming channels into the TV’s channel memory (continued)
To add a channel to the channel memory:
Manually adding and deleting channels in
Highlight the unchecked box next to the channel number
you want to add, and then press ENTER to check the box.
the channel memory
After automatically programming channels into the channel
memory, you can manually add or delete individual channels.
To manually add digital subchannels on a physical channel:
Use the Channel Numbers and the Dash (–/100) on the
remote control to enter the channel number (for example,
56–1).
To add or delete channels in the channel memory:
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown in
step 3).
If the channel is found, the number will be added to the list
and the box will be checked.
If the channel is not found, a message will appear.
To remove a channel from the channel memory:
Setup
Highlight the checked box next to the channel number you
want to remove, and then press ENTER to uncheck the
box.
Installation
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
HDMI 1 Audio
Auto
Auto
To save your new settings:
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
2 Sec
Highlight Done and press ENTER.
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
To revert to your original settings:
3. Open the Terrestrial menu, highlight Channel Add/Delete,
and then press ENTER.
Highlight Cancel and press ENTER before saving.
To remove all channels from the channel memory:
Highlight Reset and press ENTER, and then highlight
Done and press ENTER.
Note:
Terrestrial
Input Configuration
Channel Program
Channel Add/Delete
Signal Meter
• This action applies to the current antenna input only. To
delete/add channels on the other input, highlight the input
you want (ANT1 or ANT 2) and press ENTER.
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
• This action cannot be cancelled unless you highlight Cancel
and press ENTER before saving your changes.
4. The illustration below left shows channels programmed for
the ANT 1 antenna input. To view the list of channels
programmed for the ANT 2 or Cable box antenna input,
press the y z buttons to highlight either “ANT 2” or
“Cable Box” and press ENTER.
Channel Add/Delete
ANT 1
ANT 1
Analog
Digital
Digital
Analog
Analog
Digital
Analog
Analog
Digital
Analog
2
2 - 1
2 - 2
3
ANT 2
Cable Box
4
5
Note: “Cable Box” will appear only if you connected a cable
box to your TV.
6
7
Reset
Cancel
Done
7 - 1
8
Channel Add/Delete
Channel Add/Delete
ANT 1
ANT 1
Cable Box
Analog
Digital
Digital
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
Digital
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
ANT 1
2
2 - 1
2 - 2
3
1
2
ANT 2
ANT 2
Cable Box
3
Cable Box
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
Reset
Cancel
Done
8
Reset
Cancel
Done
7 - 1
8
9
10
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
48
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV
Programming your favorite channels
You can program up to 27 channels as favorite channels into
three Favorite Channel sets (nine channels from the ANT 1
input, nine from the ANT 2 input, and nine from the Cable
box input). You can then scan through your favorite channels
only, skipping other channels you do not normally watch.
To clear your favorite channel lists:
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.
2. Highlight Favorite Channels and press ENTER.
Edit Favorite Channels
3. Highlight Edit and press
ANT 2
2
ENTER.
2 - 1
To add and delete channels in the Favorite Channels sets:
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.
2. Highlight Favorite Channels and press ENTER.
3. Use the yz buttons to select either ANT 1, ANT 2, or
Cable box and press ENTER.
2 - 2
4. Highlight Reset and press
4 - 1
5
ENTER.
17 - 1
17 - 2
28 - 1
28 - 2
28 - 3
5. Highlight Done and press
ENTER.
Reset
Cancel
Done
4. Highlight Edit and press ENTER.
To tune your favorite channels for the current ANT input:
Press FAV CH yz.
Favorite Channels
ANT 1
Preferences
Favorite Channels
ANT 1
Closed Caption Mode
Off
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
To tune your favorite channels using the favorite channel
list:
ANT 2
Closed Caption Advanced
Input Labeling
Cable Box
Empty
Empty
Menu Language
Home CH Setup
English
Edit
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
CH 4-1
CH 4-2
CH 9
1. Press 100 to display the favorite channel list.
Done
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
2. Press the corresponding number button (1-9)
to select your desired channel.
CH 10
CH 12
CH 17
CH 19
---
To add a channel to the selected Favorite Channel set: Use the
yz buttons to highlight an unchecked box next to a channel you
want to set as a favorite, and then press ENTER to check the box.
Note: To tune your favorite channels for another
input, you will need to change the Input Selection
first.
---
To delete the channel from the selected Favorite Channels set:
To quickly scan through your favorite channels in a nine
picture multi-window (for the current ANT input):
Highlight a checked box and press
Edit Favorite Channels
ANT 1
2
3
4
ENTER to uncheck it.
Press FAV SCAN. See page 78 for details.
Note: If you try to add more than
nine favorite channels per input, an
error message will appear. You will
need to delete (uncheck) a channel
before you can add another.
Only 9 favorite channels are allowed,
please deselect other channels first.
Note:
9
OK
• To tune to a channel from the FAV SCAN mode, highlight a
window and press ENTER.
Reset
10
11
Cancel
Done
• To scan your favorite channels for another input, you will need to
change the Input Selection first.
When done, highlight Done and press ENTER.
To program favorite channels for another input:
Either... Highlight ANT 1, ANT 2, or Cable Box, which
will change the favorite channel settings in the selected
input. (This will not change the TV’s current input.)
Channel Numbers
100
Or... Press INPUT to select ANT 1, ANT 2, or Cable Box
and then repeat steps 1–4.
“Cable Box” will appear only if you connected a cable box
to your TV.
y
x
•
z
Favorite Channels
ANT 2
ANT 1
CH 6
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
ANT 2
Cable Box
Empty
Empty
FAV CH yz
Edit
Done
FAV SCAN
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV
Setting up and using TheaterNet™ on-screen device control
The TheaterNet feature allows you to control many brands of
IEEE1394 and/or infrared remote-controlled A/V devices
through your TV using on-screen control icons and the TV’s
remote control.
5. The TheaterNet Setup menu opens.
TheaterNet Setup
Select device
type, brand,
and IR code
from owners
manual.
Input
Video 1
Cable
Type
Brand
IR List
IR Code
General Instrum...
0000
Note:
0
0
0
0
Test
• Although the TheaterNet on-screen device control feature includes
codes for many devices, it may not include codes for some or all of
the features on certain devices you wish to control. If you are
unable to program the TheaterNet feature to operate your device
or some of the features on that device, use the device’s remote
control or the controls on the device.
Reset
Done
Using the x • buttons, select the Input the device is
connected to.
Note: When the input is changed, all unsaved settings will be
lost.
• For IR pass-through device control information, see “Controlling
infrared remote-controlled devices through the TV (IR pass-
through)” on page 21.
6. Press z and then x • to select the device Type.
7. Press z and then x • to select the device Brand.
Note: When selecting a new brand, the IR code will be set to 0.
8. Press z and then x • to select the device’s IR code.
9. If the desired IR code is found, skip to step 10.
Setting up TheaterNet
All device types except IEEE1394 require the following setup
process before you can control them using the TheaterNet on-
screen icons.
If the desired IR code is not in the list, press z and use the
Channel Number buttons to enter the device IR code.
Note: You can find the IR code for your device in the on-
screen list or in the TheaterNet device code table on pages
47–49.
All compatible IEEE1394 devices are automatically recognized
by the TheaterNet feature and do not require setup.
Note: See page 22 for details about the IEEE1394 ports. If your
IEEE1394 device is not recognized through the IEEE1394 port or
through the TheaterNet feature, it may be possible to set it up for IR
pass-through control as an infrared device (see page 21).
10. Highlight Test and press ENTER to test whether the device
responds to the code. If the device does not respond to the
code, repeat steps 8 and 9 using another code for the same
device.
To set up TheaterNet device control:
1. Make sure you have properly connected your infrared
remote-controlled device(s). See page 21 for details.
When done, highlight Done and press ENTER or choose a
different Input for which to setup TheaterNet device
control.
2. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
3. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown in
step 4).
To remove a device from TheaterNet:
1. Follow steps 1–5 above.
2. Highlight Reset and press ENTER.
Setup
Installation
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
HDMI 1 Audio
Auto
Auto
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
2 Sec
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
4. Open the Devices menu, highlight TheaterNet Devices,
and then press ENTER.
Devices
IEEE1394 Devices
TheaterNet Devices
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
50
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV
Setting up and using TheaterNet™ on-screen device control (continued)
The following are examples of the TheaterNet on-screen
control icons for various devices.
Using the TheaterNet control icons
1. Set up your infrared devices in TheaterNet, if you have not
already done so (see page 45).
Toshiba Symbio™ AVHD Recorder control*
Note: IEEE1394 devices do not need to be set up in
TheaterNet because they appear automatically in the
TheaterNet menu.
2. Press DEVICE on the remote control to display the device
TM
* If you connected a Toshiba
AVHD Recorder, you must
control selection screen.
set up the TV Guide On Screen™ system in order to use the
Symbio’s full functionality. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the
TV Guide On Screen™ system. See pages 23 and 50 for further
details about AVHD digital recorders.
TheaterNet
0
Video 2
Toshiba
1
3
Video 3
Toshiba
DEVICE
2
ColorStream HD1
Toshiba
ColorStream HD2
Toshiba
CTRL
y
x
•
z
Toshiba
ENTER
EXIT
3. Using the yzx • buttons, highlight the device you want
Toshiba
to control and press ENTER.
TheaterNet
CH
0
Video 2
Toshiba
1
3
Video 3
Toshiba
2
ColorStream HD1
Toshiba
ColorStream HD2
Toshiba
4. The input automatically changes to the input for the
selected device, and the device’s control icons display on-
screen.
Toshiba
ColorStream HD1
ENTER
TOP MENU SELECT EXIT
Highlight the icon for the function you want to control and
press ENTER.
To select the device’s control icons directly:
Press CTRL.
To close the on-screen control icons:
Press EXIT.
To view another source:
Press DEVICE and select the input source you want to
view.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV
TheaterNet™ IR device codes
Amplifiers
Cable boxes (cont.)
CD players (cont.)
Brand
Code
0406
0674
0269
0300
0160
0078
0892
0331
0892
0269
0165
0269
Brand
Code
0015
Brand
Proton
QED
Code
0157
0157
0029
Aiwa
Bose
Carver
Curtis Mathes
Denon
RadioShack
Regal
Rembrandt
Runco
0020, 0273, 0279
0011
Quasar
RCA
0000
0144
1062, 0032, 0053,
0179, 0305, 0468,
0764
0179, 0180, 0420
0157, 0420
0157
Samsung
Scientific Atlanta
GE
0877, 0008, 0017,
0477, 1877
0015
Harman/Kardon
JVC
Left Coast
Linn
Luxman
Magnavox
Marantz
NEC
Nakamichi
Optimus
Panasonic
Parasound
Philips
Pioneer
Polk Audio
RCA
Realistic
Sansui
Shure
Sony
Soundesign
Technics
Victor
Realistic
Rotel
SAE
Sansui
Sanyo
Scott
Sears
Sharp
Sherwood
Sonic Frontiers
Sony
Signal
Signature
sony
0011
1006
0003, 0015
0015
0157, 0305
0179
Starcom
Stargate
Starquest
Supercable
Tocom
Torx
Toshiba
Tusa
0305
0305
0892, 0321, 0269
0264
0015
0276
0012
0003
0000
0015
0007
0861, 0037, 0180
1067, 0180
0157
0490, 0000, 0100,
0185, 0604, 1364
0145
1208
0420
0174, 0180, 0393,
0420
0029, 0303
0072
0157, 0053
0888, 0036, 0187,
1292
0321
0395, 0300
0308, 0521
0246
0892, 0269
0013, 0300
0892, 0269
0300
United Artists
Zenith
Soundesign
TDK
Tascam
Teac
0000, 0525, 0899
CD players
Brand
Aiwa
0395
0321
0264
Code
0157, 0124
0420
Technics
Victor
Wards
Burmester
California Audio Labs
Carver
0689, 0220
0078, 0211
0308, 0521
0331
0029, 0303
0157, 0179, 0437
1297
Yamaha
Classic
Yorx
0461
DKK
DMX Electronics
Denon
0000
0157
0873, 0003
0305
Wards
Yamaha
0078, 0013, 0211
0354, 0133
Laser disk players
Brand
Aiwa
Carver
Denon
Disco Vision
Funai
Harman/Kardon
Hitachi
Magnavox
Marantz
Mitsubishi
NAD
Emerson
Fisher
GPX
Code
0203
0064, 0194, 0323
0059, 0172
0023
0174, 0179, 1325
1296
Cable boxes
Brand
ABC
Code
0003, 0008, 0014,
0007, 0011, 0017
0899
Garrard
0393, 0420
0032, 0305
0157, 0173
0032
Genexxa
Harman/Kardon
Hitachi
0203
0194
0023
Americast
Bell & Howell
Bell South
Contec
Director
Everquest
0014
0899
0019
0476
JVC
KLH
Kenwood
0072, 1294
1318, 1372, 1373
0681, 0826, 0626,
0028, 0037, 0190
1317
0194, 0217
0064, 0194
0059
0015
Koss
0059
Gemini
General Instrument
0015
Krell
LXI
Linn
MCS
MTC
Magnavox
Marantz
0157
0305
0157
0029
Optimus
Panasonic
Philips
Pioneer
Polk Audio
Quasar
Realistic
Samsung
Sega
0059
0204
0064, 0194
0059, 0023
0194
0476, 0003, 0276,
0011, 0810
0144
0009, 0020, 0273
0011
GoldStar
Hamlin
Hitachi
Hytex
Jasco
Jerrold
0420
0157, 0305
0626, 0029, 0157,
0180
0204
0203
0323
0023
0007
0015
0476, 0003, 0276,
0012, 0014, 0015,
0011, 0810
0000
0476, 1106, 0276,
0810
Miro
Mission
NSM
Nikko
Onkyo
Optimus
0000
0157
0157
0174
Sony
0193, 0201
0204
Technics
Theta Digital
Yamaha
Memorex
Motorola
0194
0217
0868, 0101
1063, 0000, 0032,
0037, 0145, 0179,
0305, 0420, 0437,
0468
0029, 0303
0420
0626, 0157
1063, 1062, 0032,
0305, 0468
0157
Oak
Pace
Panasonic
Paragon
Philips
Pioneer
0019, 0007
0237
0000, 0107
0000
Miscellaneous audio devices
Brand
Aiwa
Fisher
JVC
Jerrold
Scientific Atlanta
Sony
Code
0010, 0159, 0404
Panasonic
Parasound
Philips
0052
0073
0520, 0459
0460
0010, 0159, 0576
0459
0305, 0317
0877, 0144, 0533,
1877
Pioneer
Pulsar
Quasar
0000
0000
Polk Audio
Starcom
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
52
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV
TheaterNet™ IR device codes (continued)
Video accessory (HDTV decoder)
Receivers (cont.)
VCRs
Brand
Panasonic
Pioneer
Princeton
Samsung
Sensory Science
Sharp
Code
1120
1010
Brand
Proscan
Quasar
RCA
Code
1254
0039
Brand
Code
0048, 0209
0000
0278
0037, 0000
0041
Admiral
Adventura
Aiko
Aiwa
Akai
America Action
American High
Asha
Audiovox
Beaumark
Bell & Howell
Broksonic
0113, 0295
1190
1023, 1254, 0080,
0531, 1390, 1609
0181, 0195
1295
1126
1010
Realistic
Samsung
Sansui
0278
0035
0240
1089, 0189
0801, 1251
0186, 1286
0491, 0502, 1653
1058, 1258, 1158,
0158, 0474, 1367,
1558, 1658,1758
0670
Sanyo
Sharp
Sherwood
Sony
0037, 0278
0240
Receivers
Brand
ADC
Code
0531
1089, 1405, 0121,
0158, 0189, 0405,
1388, 1641
1390
0104
0184, 0121, 0209,
0002, 0479, 1479
0072, 0278
0037
Aiwa
Soundesign
Stereophonics
Sunfire
Teac
Technics
CCE
Calix
1023
1313
0463
Alco
Anam
Canon
Carver
Cineral
Citizen
Colt
0035
0081
0278
1609
1257
1120
1189
1390
1229
1370
0531
Apex Digital
Arcam
Audiotronic
Audiovox
Bose
Cambridge Soundworks
Capetronic
Carver
1308, 1309, 1518,
0039, 0309
1189
0037, 0278, 1278
0072
0037, 0047, 0240,
0072
0060, 0035, 0162,
0041, 0760, 1035
0240
0045, 0278, 1278
0042
Thorens
Venturer
Victor
1390
0074
Craig
Wards
0014, 0080, 0158,
0189
0176, 0186, 1176
0195
Curtis Mathes
1089, 1189, 0042,
0189
Yamaha
Yorx
Zenith
Cybernex
Daewoo
Denon
Dynatech
Electrohome
Electrophonic
Emerex
Casio
0195
0195
1136
0080
0857
Clarinette
Compaq
Curtis Mathes
Daewoo
Denon
0000
0037
0037
0032
Satellite receivers
Brand
AlphaStar
Chaparral
Crossdigital
DishPro
Echostar
Expressvu
GE
1250
1104, 1160, 0004,
1360
0042, 1801
0463
0110, 0189, 0891
1181
Code
0772
0216
Emerson
0037, 0184, 0000,
0121, 0043, 0209,
0002, 0278, 0479,
1278, 1479
0047, 0104
0035, 0033
0000
Fisher
Garrard
Harman/Kardon
Hewlett Packard
JBL
1109
1005, 0775
1005, 0775
0775
Fisher
Fuji
Funai
GE
0110, 1306
0074, 1374
1390
JVC
KLH
0566
0775
0060, 0035, 0240,
0760, 0807, 1035,
1060
0000
0432
0037, 0038, 1237
0000
GOI
Kenwood
1313, 1027, 1570,
1569, 0027, 0042,
0186
General Instrument
HTS
Hitachi
Hughes Network Systems
JVC
Magnavox
Memorex
Mitsubishi
Motorola
Next Level
Panasonic
Paysat
0869
0775
0819
Garrard
Go Video
GoldStar
Gradiente
HI-Q
Harley Davidson
Harman/Kardon
Harwood
Headquarter
Hitachi
Hughes Network Systems
JVC
Jensen
KEC
KLH
Keen
Kenwood
Kodak
LXI
Lloyd’s
Logik
MEI
MGA
MGN Technology
MTC
Koss
LXI
Lasonic
Linn
Lloyd’s
MCS
1366
0181
1798
0189
0195
0039
1142, 0749, 1749
0775
0724, 0722
0724
0047
0000
0081, 0038
0072
0749
0869
0869
Magnavox
1089, 1189, 0189,
0195, 0391, 0531
1089, 1189, 0039,
0189
0046
0000, 0042, 0041
0042
0247, 0701
0724
1142, 0749, 0724,
1076, 0722, 1749
0392
Marantz
Philips
0067, 0041
0041
0037, 0278
0072
Modulaire
Musicmagic
Nakamichi
Onkyo
0195
1089
0097
Proscan
RCA
0392, 0566, 0855,
0143
0135, 0842, 1298
1023, 0042, 0080,
0181, 0186, 0531,
0670, 0738, 0801
1518, 0039, 0309,
0367
0693
Optimus
RadioShack
SKY
Samsung
Sony
Star Choice
Toshiba
0869
0856
1109
0639
0067, 0041, 0038
0035, 0037
0037
Panasonic
0000
0072
0035
0869
Penney
Philips
0195
0749, 0790, 1052,
1053, 1054, 1285,
1286, 1287, 1289,
1749
1089, 1189, 1269,
0189, 0391, 1120
1023, 0014, 0080,
0150, 0244, 0531,
0630, 1384
0189
0240, 0043
0240
0240, 0000
1278
Pioneer
Uniden
Zenith
0724, 0722
0856, 1856
Magnasonic
Polk Audio
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV
TheaterNet™ IR device codes (continued)
VCRs (cont.)
VCRs (cont.)
DVD players (cont.)
Brand
Magnavox
Code
0035, 0039, 0081,
0000, 0149, 0563,
1781
Brand
Scott
`
Code
0184, 0045, 0121,
0043
0035, 0037, 0047,
0000, 0042, 0104,
0046, 1237
0045
Brand
Hitachi
Hiteker
JBL
Code
0573, 0664
0672
Sears
0702
0558, 0623, 0867
0717
Magnin
Marantz
Marta
0240
0035, 0081
0037
JVC
KLH
Kenwood
Semp
0490, 0534, 0682,
0737
0711, 0719, 0720,
0721
Matsushita
Memorex
0035, 0162, 0454
0035, 0162, 0037,
0048, 0039, 0047,
0240, 0000, 0104,
0209, 0046, 0454,
0479, 1037, 1162,
1237, 1262
0042
0067, 0043, 0807
0035, 0048
0000, 0072
0104, 0067, 0041,
0038
Sharp
0048, 0807, 0848
0072
Shintom
Shogun
Singer
Sonic Blue
Sony
Konka
0240
0072
Koss
0651
0798
0503, 0675
0782
0614, 0616
0035, 0032, 0000,
0033, 0636, 1032,
1232
0035, 0081, 0000,
0043, 1781
0000
Lasonic
Magnavox
Malata
Marantz
Microsoft
Mintek
Mitsubishi
Nesa
Next Base
Norcent
Onkyo
Oritron
Panasonic
Minolta
Mitsubishi
Motorola
Multitech
NEC
0539
0522
0717
0521
0717
0826
0872
Sylvania
Symphonic
TMK
Tatung
Teac
Technics
Teknika
Thomas
Tivo
Toshiba
Totevision
Unitech
Vector
Vector Research
Video Concepts
Videomagic
Videosonic
Villain
0240
0041
Nikko
0037
0240
0035
0000, 0041
0035, 0162
0035, 0037, 0000
0000
0618, 0636
0045, 0043, 0845
0037, 0240
0240
Noblex
Olympus
Optimus
0503, 0627
0651
0490, 0632, 1362,
1462, 1490
0503, 0539, 0646,
0854
0525, 0571, 0632
0539
0674
0522
0522, 0571, 0717,
0822
1062, 0162, 0037,
0048, 0104, 0432,
0454, 1048, 1162,
1262
0184, 0209, 0002,
0479, 1479
1062, 0035, 0162,
0225, 0454, 0616,
1035, 1162, 1262
0035, 0037, 0240,
0042, 0038, 1035,
1237
Philips
Orion
Pioneer
Polk Audio
Princeton
Proscan
RCA
0045
0038
0045
0037
0240
0000
Panasonic
Penney
Rotel
Rowa
Sampo
Samsung
Sansui
0623
0823
0698
Wards
0060, 0035, 0048,
0047, 0081, 0240,
0000, 0042, 0072,
0149, 0760
0209, 0072, 1278
0035, 0000, 0072
0038
Pentax
Philco
Philips
0042
0035, 0209, 0479
0035, 0081, 0618,
1081, 1181
0037
0573, 0820
0695
White Westinghouse
XR-1000
Yamaha
Sanyo
Sharp
0670
0630
0633
0533
Pilot
Pioneer
Polk Audio
Profitronic
Proscan
Protec
0067
0081
0240
Sherwood
Shinsonic
Sony
Sylvania
Technics
Techwood
Theta Digital
Toshiba
Tredex
Zenith
0039, 0000, 0209,
0033, 0479, 1479
0533, 0864, 1533
0675, 0821
0490
0692
0571
0503, 0695, 1045
0800
0060, 0760, 1060
0072
Pulsar
0039
0046
0046
DVD players
Brand
Aiwa
Apex Digital
Quarter
Quartz
Quasar
Code
0641
0672, 0717, 0755,
0794, 0796, 0797,
0830, 0856, 1100
0736
0035, 0162, 0454,
1035, 1162
0060, 0240, 0042,
0149, 0760, 0807,
1035, 1060
0000, 1037
0037
Urban Concepts
XBox
0503
0522
RCA
Audiologic
B & K
0655, 0662
0571
RadioShack
Radix
Randex
Blue Parade
Broksonic
DVD2000
Daewoo
Denon
Emerson
Enterprise
Fisher
GE
GPX
Go Video
Gradiente
Greenhill
Harman/Kardon
0695
0521
0784
0037
Realistic
0035, 0037, 0048,
0047, 0000, 0104,
0046
0490, 0634
0591
ReplayTV
Runco
STS
Samsung
Sanky
0614, 0616
0039
0591
0670
0522, 0717
0699, 0769
0715
0651
0717
0582, 0702
0042
0240, 0045
0048, 0039
0000, 0067, 0209,
0041, 0479, 1479
0047, 0240, 0104,
0046
Sansui
Sanyo
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
54
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV
Setting the AVHD device skip time
Setting the time and date
When you connect an external AVHD (audio/video hard drive)
device—such as the Toshiba Symbio™ AVHD Recorder—to
one of the TV’s IEEE1394 ports, you can use the AVHD device
skip time feature to set the number of minutes the device will
skip forward or backward when you press the SKIP buttons.
Note: If you already set up the TV Guide On Screen™ system, the
time and date were set automatically and you can skip this step.
To set the time and date:
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown in
step 3 below.)
Note:
TM
• This TV will work best with the Toshiba
AVHD
Recorder for recording high definition and standard definition
material from either tuner and for controlling live TV (pause/rewind/
etc.). When the Symbio AVHD Recorder is connected to the TV, the
remote control keys (LIVE, STOP, REW, PAUSE, PLAY, etc.) are
automatically activated to allow pausing of live TV.
3. Open the Time And Date menu, highlight Start Setup, and
press ENTER.
Time And Date
Start Setup
• When you connect an AVHD (or D-VHS) device, the TV Guide
On Screen™ system is automatically configured to allow recording. See
page 23 for device connection information. See Chapters 5 and 7 for
details about setting up and using the TV Guide On screen™ system.
To set the AVHD device skip time:
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
1. Press MENU and open
the Setup menu.
If you have not set up the TV Guide On Screen™ system, or
if you have not set up the time, the following screen will
appear. To set the time, highlight TV Guide On Screen™ and
press ENTER. The TV Guide On Screen™ setup sequence
will start, and the time and date will be set automatically.
Setup
2. Highlight AVHD Skip
1 min
3 min
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
Time and press •.
5 min
Auto
15 min
HDMI 1 Audio
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
AVHD Skip Time
3. Press y or z to select
the AVHD skip time (1,
3, 5, or 15 minutes) and
press ENTER.
AAuutoo
2 Sec
15 min
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Time And Date
Your TV Guide On Screen system can provide accurate
time and date information.
It is recommended you set up TV Guide On Screen
first and use it to obtain the time and date.
Setting the HDMI™ audio mode
Manual
TV Guide On Screen
Cancel
If you have already set up the TV Guide On Screen™
system, the time and date setting screen will appear and you
will need to manually set the time and date.
To select the HDMI audio mode:
1. Press MENU and open
the Setup menu.
Setup
Time And Date
2. Highlight HDMI 1 (or
Installation
Auto
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
Digital
Analog
2) Audio and press •.
Date (MM/DD/YY)
Time (HH:MM)
0 6 / 3 0 / 0 5
1 1 : 1 1 AM
Auto
Auto
3. Press z or y to select
the HDMI audio mode
(Auto, Digital, or
HDMI 1 Audio
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
2 Sec
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Analog) and press
ENTER. (Auto is the
Cancel
Done
recommended mode). See “Connecting an HDMI or a
DVI device to the HDMI input” on page 19.
Note:
• If you highlight TV Guide On Screen™ (above) to set the time
and date through the TV Guide On Screen™ system and a
power outage occurs, the time and date will be updated
automatically when the power is restored.
• If you highlight Manual (above) to set the time and date
manually and a power outage occurs, you will lose the time
and date settings when the power is restored.
• If you manually set the time and date and then perform TV Guide
On Screen™ setup, the manual time and date settings will be
overridden by the TV Guide On Screen™ settings.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV
Viewing the CableCARD™ menu
Setting the Quick Restart Feature
A CableCARD™ enables you to view encrypted digital channels.
See page 12 for connection and subscription information.
After the CableCARD™ is inserted, a CableCARD™ option
appears in the Applications menu, with informational screens
provided by your digital CableCARD™ service (see illustrations
below).
With the Quick Restart feature set to ON, the TV will stay in
Low Power Shutdown mode for several minutes after the TV is
turned off (see Notes below).
If the TV is turned on from Low Power Shutdown mode, the
full picture appears immediately.
To set the Quick Restart feature:
CableCard Connected -- Acquiring
channel information.
1. Press MENU, and then press x or • until the Setup menu
appears.
CableCard services will only operate
with cable signal connected to Antenna 1.
2. Highlight Quick Restart and press •.
3. Press z or y to select either On or Off.
To view the CableCARD™ menu:
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.
2. Highlight CableCARD™ and press •.
Setup
PC Settings
Off
Auto
On
HDMI 1 Audio
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
AVHD Skip Time
Gray Level
3. Press z or y to select one of the side menu items and press
Auto
2 Sec
15 min
1
ENTER to display the information.
On
Quick Restart
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Applications
TV Guide On Screen
Audio Player
IP Service
Conditional Access
CableCARD(tm) Status
Network Setup
Note:
Picture Viewer
Digital CC/Audio Selector
CableCARD
If Quick Restart is set to Off and you turn off the TV, it can take
several seconds for the picture to appear when you turn on the TV
again.
CableCARD(tm) Pairing
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
If Quick Restart is set to On and you turn off the TV, the following
will occur for a few minutes:
Note: The CableCARD™ menu is for informational purposes
only and has no user-adjustable options.
• The screen (lamp) lights dimly.
• The fans continue to run.
This is a function of the Quick Restart Low Power Shutdown mode
and is not a TV malfunction. If you do not prefer this, set the Quick
Restart feature to Off.
When the Quick Restart feature is set to Off, if you repeatedly turn
the TV on and off in a short period of time, the useful service life of
the lamp may be shorter than the average useful service life. See
page 103.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
56
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV
Viewing the digital signal meter
Viewing the system status
You can view the digital signal meter for ANT 1 and ANT 2
digital TV input sources only.
To check the system status:
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
To view the digital signal meter:
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown
below right).
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown in
step 3 below.)
Setup
Installation
System Status
System Infomation
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
Setup
HDMI 1 Audio
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
Auto
Auto
Installation
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
2 Sec
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Select
HDMI 1 Audio
Auto
Auto
HDMI 2 Audio
3. Open the System Status menu, highlight System
Information, and then press ENTER.
Slide Show Interval
2 Sec
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
4. Use the x • to scroll through the menu bar to check the
Product Information and Software Version.
3. Open the Terrestrial menu, highlight Signal Meter, and
press ENTER.
System Information
System Information
Product Information
Software Version
Brand:
Model:
Toshiba
62MX195
0.3.0
Mar 9 2005 - 12:37:10
FW:0.12
IEEE1394 GUID:
00003914-28343803
Terrestrial
Sub:47
Input Configuration
Channel program
Channel Add/Delete
Signal Meter
Done
Done
To close the screen and return to the Installation menu:
Highlight DONE and press ENTER.
To return to normal viewing:
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
4. Use the yzx • to select the antenna input and digital
Press EXIT.
channel whose signal you want to check.
Restore Factory Defaults
Note: The physical digital channel number listed in the Signal
Meter screen may not correspond to a virtual TV channel
number. Contact your local broadcasters to obtain the RF
channel numbers for your local digital stations.
To restore all settings and channels to their factory default
values:
1. Follow steps 1–3 above.
Signal Meter
Signal Locked
2. Use the x • to scroll through the menu bar to select
0
Peak
0
Factory Defaults.
Antenna
1
3. Enter your PIN code (or 0000 if no PIN code has been set).
Physical Digital Channel
Virtual Digital Channel
13
N/A
4. Highlight Yes and press ENTER. The TV will turn off
automatically after a few seconds. After the TV turns off,
unplug the TV power cord and then plug it in again to
complete the restore process.
Done
To close the screen and return to the Terrestrial menu:
Highlight DONE and press ENTER.
System Information
Press YES to confirm. After the TV
turns off, unplug it and plug it dack
in to complete the reset.
To return to normal viewing:
Press EXIT.
Yes
No
To cancel the reset:
Highlight No and press ENTER.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
57
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the TV Guide On Screen™
interactive program guide
7
The TV Guide On Screen™ system is a free, interactive,
on-screen program guide built in to your Toshiba TV that lists
schedules and information for TV programs in your area.
• Direct tuning—Directly tune the TV to a current program
you want to watch by selecting it in the program guide.
• Reminders—Schedule show reminders that will either display
an on-screen notification banner or automatically tune the TV
to the channel of the show for which you set the reminder.
Note: Over-the-air or cable access to stations carrying TV Guide
On Screen™ data is required for the TV Guide On Screen™ system to operate.
TV Guide On Screen™ system does not work with satellite programming.
Toshiba does not provide the TV Guide On Screen™ data; rather, such
data is provided by a third party, which is responsible for its accuracy and
availability. Additionally, occasional compatibility issues may exist between
the TV Guide On Screen™ system contained in your TV and the data
provided by the third party. If you experience any performance issues with
your TV Guide On Screen™ system, please contact the following:
• Recording—Easily schedule recording of one or more
programs.
Note: A VCR or IEEE1394 recording device is required for recording.
It is recommended that you connect your devices according to the
instructions in Chapter 2.
• Search—Search for shows by category, keyword, or
alphabetically.
• In the U.S., call TACP Consumer Solutions at (800) 631-
3811 or visit
http://www.tacp.com/customersupport/contact.asp.
• On-screen help—The TV Guide On Screen™ system contains
on-screen feature definitions and navigation instructions.
• In Canada, call TCL Customer Service at 1-800-268-3404
To open the TV Guide On Screen™ system:
The TV Guide On Screen™ system includes the following
features:
• While watching TV, press
the TV GUIDE button
• Streamlined on-screen assisted setup—Quickly and easily set
up your TV Guide On Screen™ system using the on-screen
prompts (see “Setting up the TV Guide On Screen™ system”
below).
Applications
on the remote control;
TV Guide On Screen
Audio Player
—or—
Picture Viewer
Digital CC/Audio Selector
• Press MENU, open the
Applications menu,
CableCARD
• Program listings and INFO windows—Scroll through eight
days of TV listings and view program information such as
rating, stereo, HDTV, new episode.
• Watch TV and display TV Guide On Screen™ information
simultaneously.
• Channel lineup customization—Customize your channel
highlight TV Guide
On Screen™, and press
ENTER.
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Note: After setting up the TV Guide On Screen™ system, the program
guide opens automatically by default when you turn on the TV. To turn
off this feature, see page 40.
lineup so your favorite stations are listed first.
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen™ system
Follow these instructions to set up the TV Guide On Screen™
system so it can receive current program data for your area.
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight Installation and then press ENTER to open the
Installation menus. (A new set of menu icons will appear
on-screen, as shown in step 3 below.)
Note: If you move the TV to a different ZIP/postal code, you will
need to perform the TV Guide On Screen™ Setup process to
reconfigure your TV Guide On Screen™ system.
3. Open the TV Guide On Screen™ Setup menu, highlight
Start, and then press ENTER.
If you have not already connected your antenna, cable box,
and/or recording device, see Chapter 2 for connection
instructions.
Note: You must connect a VCR or an IEEE1394 compatible
recording device to use the TV Guide On Screen™ system’s
one-touch recording feature. It is recommended that you
connect your devices according to the connection instructions
in Chapter 2.
Setup
Installation
TV Guide On Screen Setup
Start
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
HDMI 1 Audio
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
Auto
Auto
2 Sec
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of
television programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is
prohibited under the Copyright Laws of the United States and
other countries, and may subject you to civil and criminal liability.
4. Go to Chapter 5 for instructions on completing the setup.
Read this chapter for details on using the TV Guide
On Screen™ interactive program guide.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
58
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
Navigating the TV Guide On Screen™ system
• While watching TV, press
the TV GUIDE button
to enter the TV Guide
On Screen™ system. The
LISTINGS screen will
appear with the current show
highlighted.
• When in the TV Guide
On Screen™ system, if you press
the TV GUIDE button from
any screen, the TV will tune to
the show displayed in the Video
Window.
• Use the arrow keys on the
remote control (yzx •) to
highlight any show, and then
press ENTER to tune to that
show.
• Scroll left or right (x •)
to view eight days of listings.
• Press MENU to display a panel menu with options for the currently
highlighted program or tile, including setting recordings and reminders.
• To access another Service screen:
1. Press y to highlight the Service Bar.
2. Press x or • to highlight a different Service (LISTINGS, SEARCH,
Note:
•
The TV Guide On Screen™ menus shown in this manual are
for illustration purposes only. The channels, programs, and
TV Guide On Screen™ information as illustrated may not be
available in your area. The options and features as illustrated
are subject to change when updates are downloaded from the
TV Guide On Screen™ service to your TV.
SETUP, SCHEDULE, or RECORDINGS).
3. Press z to use that Service.
•
The TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide supports
cable-ready, cable box, and digital cable services, as well as
over-the-air broadcasts. It does not provide listings for satellite
services.
Note: Helpful information about each Service appears in the Info Box.
TV Guide On Screen™ remote control functions
BUTTON
FUNCTION
Numbers
TV GUIDE
• When watching TV, enters the TV Guide On Screen™ system and highlights the current show
listing.
• When in the TV Guide On Screen™ system, returns to watching TV and displays the show in
the Video Window.
– (digital
separator)
Numbers
• For direct channel tuning, priority ordering, and channel editing.
– (digital separator)
MENU
• For entering digital channel numbers.
MENU
INFO
• Displays the panel menu, in which you can choose options (for example, record, remind,
keyword).
TV GUIDE
INFO
• Cycles between levels of information, as available, in a Service screen or other type of screen.
ENTER
y
ENTER
• Makes a selection or executes an action.
• With a currently airing show listing highlighted, returns to watching TV and tunes to the show
channel.
x
•
z
• With a future airing show listing highlighted, displays a panel menu with viewing options.
PAGE UP/
DOWN
yzx •
• Provide directional control.
• When watching TV, y and z provide surfing through channels turned ON in the LISTINGS
screen.
|
|
PAGE UP/DOWN
• When in the TV Guide On Screen™ system, moves from one set of screen information to the
next, when applicable.
SS and TT
REC
• When in the TV Guide On Screen™ system or watching TV, initiates the recording process.
REC
SPLIT
• When in the TV Guide On Screen™ system, toggles between locking and unlocking the Video
Window.
SPLIT
|
|
SS and TT
• Jump forward and backward one day in the LISTINGS screen.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
59
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
Navigating the TV Guide On Screen™ system (continued)
Video Window
• When you open the
TV Guide
On Screen™ system,
the current program
appears in the Video
Window.
• As you scroll through
the listings, the Video
Window will change
to display the selected
program.
Info Box
• The lock/unlock icon indicates the status of the Video Window.
• You can set the Video Window to remain on a single channel (locked) or to
change channels (unlocked) as you navigate through listings.
To lock/unlock the Video Window:
Press the SPLIT button on the remote control to toggle between locking
and unlocking the Video Window.
—or—
Highlight a channel logo or the LISTINGS Service Bar Label and press
MENU to display the option to lock/unlock the Video Window.
Panel Menus
• A panel menu appears:
– when you press MENU on a highlighted tile (if additional options
are available); or
– when you press ENTER on a show starting in the future.
• When a panel menu appears, the highlighted tile changes color to
indicate that the panel menu relates to the tile.
• Press INFO to display help for the current panel menu.
• Press y and z to move among the options.
• Press x and • to move to adjacent options or, if the highlight is on a
odometer, to change the odometer choice.
• To move the highlight to the default command button, press ENTER
from an odometer or entry box.
• To execute the action and close the panel menu, highlight the
command button and press ENTER.
• To cancel any changes and close the panel menu:
– press MENU; or
– highlight Cancel and press ENTER.
• If a panel menu contains more options than can be displayed in one
panel, the word “more” appears at the bottom of the menu. To access
the additional options, either scroll down using the z button or the
PAGE UP/DOWN (CH yz) button.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
60
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
Navigating the TV Guide On Screen™ system (continued)
Info Box
• An Info Box contains information about a show, Service, or Panel Ad, or
provides general help (for example, for a panel menu).
Info Action Bar
• An Info Box for a program in the LISTINGS screen can have up to three
sizes: Small, Large, or “No.”
– Press INFO on the remote control to cycle among the sizes.
– The default Info Box size is Small. To change the default size, open the
SETUP Service screen (see page 66).
Small Info Box
• The Info Button icon (
) appears on the Info Action Bar if the Info
Box size can change and/or if there are additional Info screens. Press the
INFO key on the remote control to change the size and/or to display
additional Info screens.
• In some instances, the INFO button on the remote control is used to page
forward (for example, if there are additional pages of information in a Panel
Ad, a Channel Ad, or help text).
Large Info Box
TV Guide On Screen™ Icons
ICON
NAME
DESCRIPTION
Info Button
• Additional Info Box information is available, or the Info Box has additional sizes.
Progress Bar • Elapsed time in current show.
• Progress bar appears in LISTINGS and SEARCH and when the Info Button is pressed while watching TV.
HDTV
New
• Show is presented in high-definition TV, if available.
• Show is new (not a repeat).
Stereo
• Show is available in stereo.
Dolby Digital • Show is available with Dolby Digital 5.1 audio (digital channels only).
CC
• Closed captioning is available for the show.
TV Rating
• TV rating for the show.
Record Once • Show is set to Record Once.
• Other frequencies are Daily (manual recording only),
Regularly, and Weekly.
Record Off
• Show is set to Record but is currently Off (show remains in Schedule).
• Show is Suspended due to a schedule conflict (show remains in Schedule).
Record
Suspended
• Recording resumes when the conflict no longer exists.
Remind Once • Show is set to Remind Once.
• Other frequencies are Daily (manual reminding only),
Regularly, and Weekly.
Remind Off
• Show is set to Remind but is currently Off (show remains in Schedule).
Remind
• Show is Suspended due to a schedule conflict (show remains in Schedule).
Suspended
• Remind resumes when the conflict no longer exists.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
61
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
TV Guide On Screen™ Services
The TV Guide On Screen™ system consists of five main services: LISTINGS, SEARCH, RECORDINGS, SCHEDULE, and SETUP.
Note:
• For the RECORDINGS service to display, an IEEE1394 recording device must be connected to the television (see Chapter 2); otherwise, only
four services display. Recording to other devices, such as a VCR, are possible from within the LISTINGS service.
• When using the TV Guide On Screen™ system to record a program for the first time, it is recommended that you perform a test recording to
make sure your system is set up properly.
• If the power is cut or the plug becomes disconnected during timer recording, any recorded contents will be lost.
• If the TV power cord is unplugged for an extended period of time, it may take up to 24 hours with the TV in standby mode (power cord
plugged in and power OFF) to download the entire TV Guide On Screen™ program schedule. It may take up to a week before an entire
program schedule is available. Be sure to follow the instructions under “TV Guide On Screen™ Reminder” on page 40.
LISTINGS screen
• When you open the TV Guide On Screen™ system,
LISTINGS is always the first service displayed.
• Use the Number keys on the remote control to jump to a
specific channel’s listings.
• To watch a show (if on now), highlight the show and press
ENTER.
• To display the Episode Options panel menu for a particular
show, highlight a show and press MENU.
• With LISTINGS highlighted in the Service Bar, press INFO
to display a help screen. Press INFO again to close the screen.
Episode Options panel menu
From the Episode Options panel menu, you can choose to set a
recording, set a reminder, or tune to the channel. The following
are descriptions of the buttons.
• Use the arrow keys to move the highlight within LISTINGS
to do the following:
– View eight days of show listings
– Read show descriptions
GO TO SERVICE BAR: Closes the menu, changes no
information, and returns to the Service Bar.
TUNE TO CHANNEL / WATCH NOW: Exits the TV Guide
On Screen™ system and tunes to the channel of the highlighted
show (if the show airs in the future) or tunes to the show (if the
show is currently airing). The button label changes according to
whether the show is currently airing or not.
SET RECORDING: Displays the Record Options panel menu,
from which you can set the show to record. For additional
information, see “SCHEDULE screen” and “Record features”
on page 61.
SET REMINDER: Displays the Remind Options panel menu,
from which you can set a reminder for the show. For additional
information, see “SCHEDULE screen” on page 61 and
“Remind features” on page 63.
– Tune directly to a show currently airing
– Set a show to Remind (e.g., start time, frequency, automatic
power ON, auto-tune TV)
– Set a show to Record (e.g, start/end time, frequency)
– Lock and unlock the Video Window
CANCEL: Closes the menu, changes no information, and
returns to the highlighted show.
– Access panel ads and channel ads
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
62
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
TV Guide On Screen™ Services (continued)
SEARCH screen
• SEARCH allows you to find shows by keyword,
alphabetically, or by category (HDTV, Movies, Sports,
Children, Educational, News, Variety, Series).
Example: Category search
1. From the SEARCH screen, press z to highlight a category
(in this example, MOVIES).
• With SEARCH highlighted in the Service Bar, press INFO to
display a help screen. Press INFO again to close the screen.
2. Press z to highlight a subcategory (in this example, ALL).
• Use the arrow keys to move the highlight within SEARCH.
3. Press ENTER to display a list of all movies, organized by
date and time.
4. Highlight a show and press ENTER to watch (if on now)
or press MENU to display the Episode Options panel
menu. (See “Episode Options panel menu” on page 57.)
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
63
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
TV Guide On Screen™ Services (continued)
SEARCH screen (continued)
Example: Keyword search
6. A list of all matching shows for that keyword is displayed.
Keyword search lets you enter a word(s) to find a particular
show by category or for every show title that matches.
1. From the SEARCH screen, highlight KEYWORD, and
then press ENTER.
2. Highlight NEW SEARCH in the panel menu, and then
press ENTER.
7. Highlight a show and press ENTER to display all airings.
Then highlight a specific listing and press ENTER to watch
(if on now) or press MENU to display the Episode Options
panel menu. From the Episode Options menu, you can
choose to set a recording or reminder, or tune to the
channel (see “Episode Options panel menu” on page 57.)
3. The Search Options panel menu opens. Highlight
CATEGORY, and then use the arrow keys to highlight a
category to search (All, HDTV, Children, Sports, etc.).
4. After highlighting a category, press z to highlight ENTER
KEYWORD, and then press ENTER.
The TV Guide On Screen™ system stores all the keywords you
create.
To edit or delete a keyword:
From the SEARCH/KEYWORD screen, highlight the
keyword you want to edit or delete, and then press MENU
to display the Search Options panel menu, with the
following options:
5. The keyboard is displayed. Use the arrow keys to highlight
a character and then press ENTER to display it. When
finished entering all characters, highlight DONE and press
ENTER.
– GO TO SERVICE BAR: Closes the menu, changes no
information, and returns to the Service Bar.
– EDIT SEARCH: Displays the keyboard, from which you
can change the keyword.
– DELETE SEARCH: Displays the Confirmation panel
menu. Select YES to delete the search or NO to close the
panel menu.
– CANCEL: Closes the panel menu, changes no
information, and returns to the highlighted show.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
64
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
TV Guide On Screen™ Services (continued)
RECORDINGS screen
The RECORDINGS service screen displays a list of previously
recorded or currently recording shows on an IEEE1394
recording device connected to the TV (see Chapter 2).
To view a recording, you can do one of the following:
• Highlight an episode and press ENTER to view it now. The
episode either starts from the beginning or from where it
was last stopped (if viewed previously).
Note: RECORDINGS will not appear in the Service Bar unless you
have an IEEE1394 video recording device connected to one of the
IEEE1394 ports on the TV. See Chapter 2 for details.
• Highlight an episode and press MENU to display the
Episode Options panel menu, with the following options:
For additional details, see “Record features” on page 61.
– GO TO SERVICE BAR: Closes the menu, changes no
information, and returns to the Service Bar.
• With RECORDINGS highlighted in the Service Bar, press
INFO to display a help screen. Press INFO again to close the
screen.
– RESUME: Starts from the beginning or from where it
was last stopped (if viewed previously).
– PLAY FROM BEGINNING: Starts from the beginning,
even if stopped previously.
– DELETE EPISODE: Deletes the episode from the
RECORDINGS list and deletes the recording from the
IEEE1394 recording device. A Confirm panel menu
displays. Press YES to delete the episode or NO to close
the panel menu.
To choose the way recordings are displayed:
– CANCEL: Closes the panel menu, changes no
information, and returns to the highlighted show.
1. Highlight RECORDINGS on the Service Bar, and press
MENU to display the Recording Options panel menu.
2. Press yz to choose between View As and Sort By, as
described below.
View As: Press x • to choose between the following:
• List—Displays every recorded episode for a show (see
example in Screen B, at right).
Note: In List view, highlight an episode to display an Info
Box with show information. Press MENU to display the
Episode Options panel menu (see “Episode Options
panel menu” on page 57).
Screen A
• Group—Displays recorded shows without listing every
recorded episode (see example in Screen A, at right).
Note: In Group view, highlight a show and press ENTER
to view all recorded episodes. Press ENTER again to
collapse the episode list.
Screen B
Sort By: Press x and • to choose between the following:
• Title—Displays recorded shows in alphabetical order (see
example in Screen A, at right).
• Date—Displays recorded shows by date and time, with
most recent first (see example in Screen B, at right).
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject
you to civil and criminal liability.
3. When finished, press ENTER to highlight DONE, and
then press ENTER again to close the panel menu and
display the recordings with the selected options.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
65
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
TV Guide On Screen™ Services (continued)
SCHEDULE screen
The SCHEDULE service screen allows you to review, edit, or
delete Record and Remind events you set previously.
Record features
You can set a show to Record, or edit the record settings for a
show, in LISTINGS, SEARCH, and SCHEDULE. There are
three ways to set a show to Record, as described below.
1) Set a show to Record using the REC key on the
remote control
Press the REC key on the remote control to record the
show Once with current default settings (start and end
recording on time). Each time you press REC, you change
the Record frequency (but not the default settings) among
Once (default), Regularly, Weekly, and Cancel.
• With SCHEDULE highlighted in the Service Bar, press
INFO to display a help screen. Press INFO again to close
the screen.
Note: The related Record icon appears on the show tile
each time you press REC. See “Record icons,” on page 62.
2) Set a show to Record from a panel menu
1. Highlight a show and press MENU to display the
Episode Options panel menu.
2. Highlight SET RECORDING and press ENTER to
display the Record Options panel menu.
• Highlight an event and press MENU to display the Schedule
Options panel menu, with the following options:
– GO TO SERVICE BAR: Closes the menu, changes no
information, and returns to the Service Bar.
– WATCH NOW: Exits the TV Guide On Screen™ system
and tunes to the highlighted show.
3. Highlight the FREQUENCY field, and press x or • to
choose among Once, Regularly, Weekly, or Off.
– DELETE RECORDING: Removes the recording from
the schedule. A Confirm panel menu displays. Press YES
to delete the recording or NO to close the panel menu.
4. Highlight the START field, and press x or • to choose
in the range from 120 minutes early to 120 minutes late
or On Time (default = On Time).
– EDIT RECORDING: Opens a menu in which you can
change existing recording information.
5. Repeat step 4 for the END field.
– SET REMINDER: Opens a menu in which you can set a
reminder for the show (Record is not cancelled).
6. Highlight the RECORDER field and press x or • to
choose the recording device.
Note: For connected IEEE1394 recording devices only.
– CANCEL: Closes the panel menu, changes no
information, and returns to the highlighted show.
7. Highlight the KEEP UNTIL field and press x or • to
choose how long you want to keep the Record event.
Note: For connected IEEE1394 recording devices only.
An icon identifies the event type. For more details, see “Record
features,”at right, and “Remind features” on page 63.
8. Press ENTER to highlight SCHEDULE RECORDING,
and press ENTER again to close the menu.
A Record icon for the selected frequency appears on the
show tile. See “Record icons” on page 62.
Note: For connected IEEE1394 recording devices only.
Or highlight CANCEL and press ENTER to close the
menu, change no information, and return to the
highlighted show.
Note: You can change the default values of the Record Options
panel menu fields. See “Change default options” on page 66.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
66
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
TV Guide On Screen™ Services (continued)
Record features (continued)
3) Manually set a show to Record
Record conflict
1. Highlight SCHEDULE in the Service Bar, and press
MENU to display the Schedule Options panel menu.
A conflict message appears for the following reasons:
• A show set to Record overlaps with any part of another
show previously set to Record.
2. Highlight NEW MANUAL RECORDING and press
ENTER to display the Record Options panel menu.
• A show set to Record overlaps with a show previously set to
auto-tune. (For auto-tune details, see “Remind features” on
page 63.)
Press yzx • to move through the options.
Press the Number keys or yzx • to change the
information, as necessary.
Select one of these options:
3. Enter the information in the panel menu fields. You will
need to set the start and end time for the recording. For
details, see “Set a show to Record from a panel menu” on
the previous page.
• Record Anyway—This show will override an existing show
set to Record or auto-tune.
• Don’t Record This Show—Cancels the Recording.
Note: When setting a Manual Recording, the frequency
option “Daily” is available instead of “Regularly.” See “Record
icons,” below right, for a description of Record icons.
4. When finished entering the information in the fields,
press ENTER to highlight SCHEDULE RECORDING,
and press ENTER again to close the menu.
A Record icon for the selected frequency appears on the
show tile. See “Record Icons,” below right.
Note: Manual recording is listed by channel number.
Or highlight CANCEL and press ENTER to close the
menu, change no information, and return to the
highlighted show.
Record icons
Following is a description of the Record icons that will appear
on the tile for a show set to Record.
When using the TV Guide On Screen™ system to record a program for the
first time, it is recommended that you perform a test recording to make
sure your system is set up properly.
• Record Once
—Records the show one time.
• Record Regularly
show airs on the same channel and starts at the same time.
—Records the show every time the
Recording notification banner
• If the TV is not on, the recording occurs as scheduled.
• If the TV is on and you are watching the channel that is set to
record, the recording occurs as scheduled.
• Record Weekly —Records the show every time the show
airs on the same day of the week and on the same channel,
and starts at the same time.
• If the TV is on and you are watching a channel other than
the one that is set to record, a notification banner (illustrated
below) appears on-screen before recording starts. At that time
you can choose to start or cancel recording.
• Record Daily
—Records on the same channel and at the
same start time every weekday (Monday through Friday).
The default highlighted item in the notification banner is
“Change channel; start recording.” If no change is made
within 3 minutes, the notification banner will close
automatically, the channel will change to the one set to
record, and the recording will occur as scheduled. If you want
to cancel the recording, select “Don’t change; cancel
recording” in the notification banner and press ENTER.
Note: This icon displays for manual recordings only.
• Record Suspend
—Recording is Suspended due to a
schedule conflict (show remains in Schedule).
• Record Off
—Keeps the Recording in the Schedule list
but will not record this show until the frequency is changed.
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject
you to civil and criminal liability.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
67
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
TV Guide On Screen™ Services (continued)
Remind features
You can set a Reminder to perform the following functions:
Or highlight CANCEL and press ENTER to close the
menu, change no information, and return to the
highlighted show.
• Automatically turn on the TV (if off) at the scheduled
reminder time, and tune the TV to the channel of the show
for which you set the reminder.
2) Manually set a show Reminder
• Automatically tune the TV, at the scheduled reminder time,
to the channel of the show for which you set the reminder.
1. Highlight SCHEDULE in the Service Bar, and press
MENU to display the Schedule Options panel menu.
• Display an on-screen notification banner (reminding you that
the show is about to start), from which you can choose to
tune the TV to the show’s channel or cancel the reminder.
2. Highlight NEW MANUAL REMINDER and press
ENTER to display the Remind Options panel menu.
Press yzx • to move through the options.
You can set a show reminder, or edit the reminder settings for a
show, in LISTINGS, SEARCH, and SCHEDULE. There are
two ways to set a show reminder, as described below.
Press the Number keys or yzx • to change the
information, as necessary.
1) Set a show Reminder from a panel menu
1. Highlight a show and press MENU to display the
Episode Options panel menu.
2. Highlight SET REMINDER and press ENTER to
display the Remind Options panel menu.
3. Enter the information in the panel menu fields. You will
need to set the start and end time for the reminder. For
details, see “Set a show reminder from a panel menu,”
at left.
Note: When setting a Manual Reminder, the frequency
option “Daily” is available instead of “Regularly.” See “Remind
icons,” on the following page, for a description of Reminder
icons.
3. Highlight the FREQUENCY field, and press x or • to
choose among Once, Regularly, Weekly, or Off.
4. When finished entering the information in the fields,
press ENTER to highlight SCHEDULE REMINDER,
and press ENTER again to close the menu.
4. Highlight the POWER ON TV field, and press x or •
to choose either Yes (to turn on the TV automatically, if
off, at the scheduled Reminder time) or No (default).
A Remind icon for the selected frequency appears on the
show tile. See “Remind icons” on the following page.
Note: Manual reminders are listed by channel number.
5. Highlight the AUTO TUNE TV field, and press x or •
to choose either Yes (to automatically tune the TV to the
channel you are setting the Reminder for at the
scheduled Reminder time; the TV must be on at the
time) or No (default).
Or highlight CANCEL and press ENTER to close the
menu, change no information, and return to the
highlighted show.
Note: You can change the default values of the Remind
Options panel menu fields. See “Change default options” on
page 66 for details.
6. Highlight the WHEN field (to set a time for displaying
the reminder screen), and press x or • to choose in the
range from 15 minutes early to 15 minutes late or On
Time (default = 1 minute early).
7. Press ENTER to highlight SCHEDULE REMINDER,
and press ENTER again to close the menu. A Remind
icon for the selected frequency appears on the show tile.
See “Remind icons” on page 64.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
68
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
TV Guide On Screen™ Services (continued)
Remind features (continued)
Reminder notification banner
Based on your option settings, a notification banner will appear
on-screen, if your TV is on at the scheduled Reminder time.
Remind icons
Following is a description of the Remind icons that will appear
on the tile for a show set to Remind.
At that time you can either press ENTER to hide the Reminder
banner, or highlight the show and press ENTER to tune to
the show.
• Remind Once
—Displays a show reminder one time.
• Remind Regularly
time the show airs on the same channel and starts at the same
time.
—Displays a show reminder every
If no choice is made within 3 minutes, the notification banner
closes automatically and completes the highlighted item (default
is HIDE REMINDERS).
Note: If more than two reminders are set for the same time,
arrows appear on the Reminder notification banner. Press yz
to highlight the shows.
• Remind Daily
weekday (Monday through Friday) for the same channel and
start time.
—Displays a show Reminder every
Note: This icon displays for manual reminders only.
• Remind Suspend
—Reminder is Suspended due to a
schedule conflict (show remains in Schedule).
Remind conflict
A conflict message appears for the following reasons:
• Remind Off
but will not display a reminder until you change the
frequency.
—Keeps the Reminder in the Schedule list
• A show set with an auto-tune Reminder has the same start
time as an existing auto-tune Reminder.
• A show set with an auto-tune Reminder overlaps with a
scheduled Recording.
Select one of these options:
• Auto-Tune Anyway—This show will override an existing
show set to auto-tune.
• Proceed, No Auto-Tune—Set the show as a Reminder but
do not auto-tune.
• Don’t Set This Reminder—Cancels the Reminder.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
69
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
TV Guide On Screen™ Services (continued)
SETUP screen
After you complete the initial TV Guide On Screen™ setup (as
described in Chapter 5), you can change the following settings:
• Change system settings
• Change channel display
• Change default options
Change channel display
This option allows you to edit channel information that appears
in LISTINGS, including the following:
• Reorder the position the channels appear in LISTINGS.
• Change the “tune channel” number.
Highlight a choice, press ENTER, and follow the on-screen
instructions.
Note: The “tune channel” is the channel on which you receive
a station. For example, two viewers in the same zip code may
receive the same station on different channel numbers,
depending on whether they have Cable service or are using a
cable box.
• Switch a channel to one of the following settings:
– On (channel is always displayed in LISTINGS)
– Off (channel is never displayed in LISTINGS)
– Auto-Hide (channel is displayed in LISTINGS only
when program information is available)
With SETUP highlighted in the Service Bar, press INFO to
display a help screen. Press INFO again to close the screen.
1. From the SETUP screen, highlight CHANGE CHANNEL
DISPLAY and press ENTER.
2. Highlight the channel row you want to edit and press
ENTER to display the Grid Options panel menu.
Change system settings
This option appears only after you have completed the initial
TV Guide On Screen™ setup process (as described in Chapter 5).
1. From the SETUP screen, highlight CHANGE SYSTEM
SETTINGS and press ENTER.
3. To edit the options, press INFO and follow the on-screen
instructions.
2. Press ENTER again
to display the
Confirming Your
Settings screen.
3. Highlight one of the
options, press
ENTER, and follow
the on-screen
instructions.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
70
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen™ interactive program guide
TV Guide On Screen™ Services (continued)
SETUP screen (continued)
Change default options
This option allows you to change default settings in the
following categories:
Record defaults
1. From the SETUP screen, highlight CHANGE DEFAULT
OPTIONS and press ENTER.
2. Highlight RECORD DEFAULTS and press MENU to
display the Record Defaults panel menu.
• General Defaults
• Record Defaults
• Remind Defaults
General defaults
1. From the SETUP screen, highlight CHANGE DEFAULT
OPTIONS and press ENTER.
3. Enter the required information in the panel menu fields
(start time, end time, recorder choice, how long to keep a
Record event, the quality of the recording). See “Record
features” on page 61 for details on entering values in these
fields.
4. When finished, press ENTER to highlight DONE, and
press ENTER again to close the menu and accept the
changes (or highlight CANCEL to close the menu with
no changes).
2. Highlight GENERAL DEFAULTS and press MENU to
display the General defaults panel menu.
Remind defaults
1. From the SETUP screen, highlight CHANGE DEFAULT
OPTIONS and press ENTER.
2. Highlight REMIND DEFAULTS and press MENU to
display the Remind Defaults panel menu.
3. Enter the following information in the panel menu fields:
• BOX SIZE: The initial Info Box size when you open the
TV Guide On Screen™ system. Choices are No, Small
(default), Large, and Last Used.
• BOX CYCLE: The Info Box size rotation when you press
INFO on the remote control when the TV Guide
On Screen™ system is open. Choices are No Only, Small
Only, Large Only, No & Small, No & Large, Small &
Large, and All (default).
3. Enter the required information in the panel menu fields
(power On TV, auto-tune, when to display the Remind
screen). See “Remind features” on page 63 for details on
entering values in these fields.
• AUTO GUIDE: Automatic entry into the TV Guide
On Screen™ system when the TV is powered on. Choices
are On (default) and Off.
4. When finished, press ENTER to highlight DONE, and
press ENTER again to close the menu and accept the
changes (or highlight CANCEL to close the menu with
no changes).
Note: Set the AUTO GUIDE to Off if you do not want the
TV Guide On Screen™ system to open every time you turn
on the TV.
4. When finished, press ENTER to highlight DONE, and
press ENTER again to close the menu and accept the
changes (or highlight CANCEL to close the menu with no
changes).
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
71
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the TV’s features
8
Selecting the video input source to view
To select the video input source to view:
1. Press INPUT on the remote control or TV/VIDEO on the
TV control panel.
2. Press 0–9 to select the input source you want to view, which
will depend on the input terminals you used to connect
your devices (see Chapter 2).
Numbers
INPUT
The current signal source displays in the top right corner of
the Input Selection screen.
Input Selection
ANT 1
y
z
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
ANT 1
Video 1
Video 2
Video 3
ColorStream HD1
ColorStream HD2
HDMI 1
HDMI 2
PC
ANT 2
0
9
INPUT
to Select
-
/
Note:
• When the Input Selection screen is open, you also can use the yz
buttons on the remote control (or the Channel
control panel) to change the input.
buttons on the
Remote control
• You can repeatedly press the INPUT button on the remote control
or the TV/VIDEO button on the TV control panel to change the
input.
• To select an IEEE1394 input source, press the TheaterNet DEVICE
button on the remote control (see page 26 and 45).
• If an IEEE1394 device is the current input, it will appear at the
bottom of the Input Selection list; however, it will not display in the
list if you change the input source.
TV control panel
• You can label the video input sources according to the specific
devices you have connected to the TV (see “Labeling the video
input sources” on the next page).
• The source can be “hidden.” See page 68 for details.
CHANNEL
{
TV/VIDEO
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
72
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Labeling the video input sources
You can label each video input source according to the type of
device you connected to each source, from the following preset
list of labels:
4. Press x or • to select the desired label for that input source.
If a particular input is not used, you can select “Hide” as
the label, which will cause that input to be “grayed out” in
the input list and skipped over when you press the INPUT
button on the remote control.
– – (default label)
Hide (to hide an unused input in the Input Selection
window)
Note: If you select “Hide” for all of the input labels, the POP
feature will be disabled. If you then attempt to access the POP
feature, the message “Not available” will appear on-screen.
Audio Receiver
VCR
Video Recorder
Laser Disk
Compact Disc
DVD
5. To save the new input labels, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory default labels, highlight
Reset and press ENTER.
Input labeling example:
The screen below left shows the default Input Selection screen
(with none of the inputs labeled). The screen below right is an
example of how you could label the inputs if you had connected
a DVD player to VIDEO 1, Cable TV to VIDEO 2, an audio
receiver to VIDEO 3, a video recorder to ColorStream HD1, a
DTV set-top box to HDMI 1, and a satellite/DSS set-top box to
HDMI 2. Also note that the ColorStream HD2 input is labeled
“Hidden,” which means that the input will be skipped over
when INPUT or TV/VIDEO is pressed.
DTV
Satellite/DSS
Cable
Game Console
Note:
• If you set up devices in TheaterNet,™ the associated inputs are
automatically labeled and cannot be relabeled until you remove the
device from TheaterNet (see page 45).
• If you set up a cable box in VIDEO 1, that input will be labeled
automatically and cannot be relabeled until you remove the device
from the TV Guide On Screen™ setup.
• You cannot select IEEE1394 devices through the Input Selection
window; however, you can select and control IEEE1394 devices
through TheaterNet (see page 45).
Input Selection
ANT 1
Input Selection
ANT 1
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
ANT 1
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
ANT 1
DVD
Video 1
Cable
Video 2
Audio Receiver
Video 3
Video Receiver
ColorStream HD1
ColorStream HD2
HDMI 1
ColorSteram HD2 (Hidden)
DTV
To label the video input sources:
Satellite/DSS
PC
HDMI 2
PC
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.
2. Highlight Input Labeling and press ENTER.
ANT 2
ANT 2
0
9
INPUT to Select
0
9
INPUT to Select
-
/
-
/
3. Press y or z to highlight the video source you want to
Input Selection screen
with no inputs labeled
Input Selection screen with
all inputs labeled except input 5,
which has been hidden.
label.
To clear the input labels:
Preferences
Favorite Channels
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.
2. Highlight Input Labeling and press ENTER.
3. Highlight Reset and press ENTER.
Closed Caption Mode
Closed Caption Advanced
Input Labeling
Off
Menu Language
Home CH Setup
English
Note: If you set up a device in TheaterNet, its input label will
not be cleared unless you remove the device from TheaterNet
(see page 45).
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Input Labeling
Video 1
DVD
Cable
Video 2
Video 3
Audio Receiver
ColorStream HD 1
ColorStream HD 2
HDMI 1
Video Receiver
Hide
DTV
HDMI 2
Satellite/DSS
PC
--
--
ANT 2
Reset
Done
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
73
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Tuning channels
Using the ChannelBrowser™
The channel browser stores the most recently viewed channels (up to 32) in the channel history. This feature allows you to:
• Keep a separate, temporary* history of the last 32 channels tuned from each of three inputs: ANT 1, ANT 2, and Cable Box.
*Note: Turning off the TV will clear the channel history for all three inputs.
• Quickly surf and tune your recently viewed channels from the channel browser banner (illustrated below).
• Surf via Browse mode (to immediately tune channels as you highlight them in the channel browser banner) or Select mode (to surf
over channels in the browser banner before you select one to tune).
• Set a “HOME” channel for the ANT 1, ANT 2, and Cable Box inputs.
To open the channel browser banner: Press x ( ), • ( ), or ENTER on the remote control.
– Press x ( ) to surf back from the most recently viewed channel through the last 32 channels that were tuned from the current
input, which are automatically stored in the channel history for the current input (ANT 1, ANT 2, or Cable Box only).
– Press • ( ) to surf forward from the previous channels in the channel history up to the most recently viewed channel.
Elements of the channel browser banner
Active channel
status
Highlighted channel
Channels stored
in the channel
history
Active channel
Home channel instructions
or • (
(Displays with a yellow
background in Select mode.
Displays with a yellow
(In Browse mode, because the highlighted
channel is tuned automatically, the active
channel and the highlighted channel
will always be the same.)
[Press x (
)
)
(Displays in this area
only if available.)
to surf the other channels
in the channel history.]
outline in Browse mode.)
Hold HOME key
3 sec to program
12-3
12345678
14
26-1
QRS
17-2
TUV
3
XYZ
ABCD-DTV
CB
ANT 1 CABLE 3
XYZ
480p
17-2
Select Mode
Current mode
Current
input
Current
antenna type
(cable or TV)
Active
channel
number
Channel call
letters
(if available)
Resolution
Home channel
(Select or Browse)
To toggle between Browse mode and Select mode:
After opening the channel browser banner, press y or z to toggle between Browse mode and Select mode. The “Current mode” field
on the channel browser banner will flash green. Note: The channel browser banner opens in Browse mode by default.
To tune to a channel in Browse mode:
To tune to a channel in Select mode:
1. While watching TV, press x ( ) or •( ) to open the
channel browser banner and surf back to a previous channel
or forward to the next channel in the channel history.
1. While watching TV, press x ( ) or •( ) to open the
channel browser banner and surf back to a previous channel
or forward to the next channel in the channel history.
In Browse mode, when you stop on a channel number in
the browser banner, it will be highlighted with a yellow
outline and the TV will automatically tune to the channel.
In Select mode, when you stop on a channel number in
the browser banner, it will be highlighted with a yellow
background but the TV will not automatically tune to the
channel.
2. Press EXIT to close the channel browser banner.
2. Press ENTER to tune the TV to the highlighted channel.
3. Press EXIT to close the channel browser banner.
Hold HOME key
3 sec to program
3
2
102-1
Ch.3
Browse Mode
ANT 1
CABLE Ch.102-1
1080i
Hold HOME key
3 sec to program
3
2
102-1
In Browse mode, the highlighted channel number is outlined
in yellow and the channel will be tuned to automatically.
Ch.3
Select Mode
ANT 1
CABLE Ch.102-1
1080i
In Select mode, the highlighted channel number has a
yellow background. Press ENTER to tune to the channel.
Note: The channel browser close automatically if you do not
make a selection within 60 seconds.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
74
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Tuning channels (continued)
Using the Channel Browser™(continued)
Adding and clearing channels in the
channel history
Setting a channel as the “Home” channel
for an input
To set a channel as Home using the remote control:
Adding channels to the channel history
1. Tune the TV to the channel you would like to set as the
Home channel for the current antenna input.
The channel browser automatically creates a history of the
last 32 channels that were tuned in the current input (ANT 1,
ANT 2, and Cable Box inputs only). A separate history will be
stored for each of these inputs.
2. Press and hold the HOME ( ) button on the remote
control for 3 seconds. When the Home channel is saved,
the channel browser banner will appear at the bottom of
the screen with the home icon flashing green.
If you change the input you are viewing:
a) you will begin a channel history for that input if one did
not exist; or
Note: You can set a different Home channel for each input
(ANT 1, ANT 2, and Cable Box inputs only).
b) you will return to the existing channel history for that input
if one had already been started.
To set a channel as Home using the menus:
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.
The channel browser will store the following channels:
2. Highlight Home CH Setup and press ENTER. The Home
CH Setup window will display.
• All channels that are tuned using the numeric buttons on the
remote control.
• All channels that are tuned for at least 7 seconds using the
CH yz buttons or the FAV CH y z buttons on the remote
control.
Home CH Setup
ANT 1
--
--
--
ANT 2
Cable Box
Note:
Reset
Done
• The channel browser banner will not appear when the POP double
window is open; however, channels tuned while the POP double
window is open will be added to the channel browser history for the
current input.
Note: "Cable Box" will appear in the Home CH Setup
window only if you connected a cable box to your TV.
• The channel browser banner will not appear in the FAV SCAN
(favorite scan) multi-window. Channels that appear in the FAV SCAN
multi-window will not be added to the channel browser history;
however, channels that are tuned from the FAV SCAN multi-window
for at least 7 seconds will be added to the channel history.
3. Use the y z buttons to select the input for which you
want to set the Home channel.
4. Use the numeric and dash (–) buttons on the remote
control to enter the desired Home channel for each input.
5. To save your entries, highlight Done and press ENTER.
To clear your entries, highlight Reset and press ENTER.
Clearing channels from the channel history
• Turning off the TV will clear all three channel histories
(ANT 1, ANT 2, and Cable Box).
To tune to the Home channel:
• Removing the CableCARD™ will clear the channel history
for the ANT 1 input.
While an input that has a set
Home channel is active, press the
HOME ( ) button on the
remote control.
• Reconfiguring the ANT 1, ANT 2, or Cable Box input
will clear the channel history for the newly configured
input(s).
Note: If you press the HOME
button while an input other than
Note: See page 41 for details on configuring the antenna inputs.
x /BACK
an antenna or Cable Box input is
selected, the TV will tune to the
most recently tuned Home
channel and input.
•/NEXT
HOME (
)
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
75
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Tuning channels (continued)
Switching between two channels using
Channel Return
The Channel Return feature allows you to switch between two
channels without entering an actual channel number each time.
Tuning your favorite channels
To tune to the channels you programmed as Favorite Channels,
see page 44.
1. Select the first channel you want to view.
Tuning to the next programmed channel
To tune to the next programmed channel:
2. Select a second channel using the Channel Number buttons
(and the dash (–) button if selecting a digital channel).
Press CHANNEL y or z on the remote control or TV control
panel.
Note:
3. Press CH RTN on the remote control. The previous
channel will display. Each time you press CH RTN, the TV
will switch back and forth between the last two channels
that were selected.
• This feature will not work unless you program channels into the
TV’s channel memory (see page 42).
Note: If you press CH RTN from a non-antenna input, the TV
will return to the last-viewed ANT input and channel. If you
are currently recording a program, this feature will not be
available.
• If you are recording a digital channel, you will only be able to
change analog channels while the recording is in progress. If you
are recording an analog channel, you will only be able to change
digital channels while the recording is in progress. This is
because the TV tuner that is being recorded (digital or analog)
will be locked on the channel that is currently recording.
Switching between two channels using
SurfLock™
The SurfLock™ feature temporarily “memorizes” one channel
in the CH RTN button, so you can return to that channel
quickly from any other channel by pressing CH RTN. To
memorize a channel in the CH RTN button:
Tuning to a specific channel
(programmed or unprogrammed)
Tuning analog channels:
Press the Channel Number buttons (0–9) on the remote
control. For example, to select channel 125, press 1, 2, 5.
1. Select the channel you want to program into the CH RTN
button.
2. Press and hold CH RTN for about 2 seconds until the
message “Channel Memorized” appears on the screen. The
channel has been programmed into the CH RTN button.
Tuning digital channels:
Press the Channel Number buttons (0–9) on the remote
control, followed by the – (dash) button and then the sub-
channel number. For example, to select digital channel 125-1,
press 1, 2, 5, –, 1.
3. You can then change channels repeatedly, and when you
press CH RTN, the memorized channel will be selected.
Note: If a digital channel is not programmed—either through
the automatic channel scan (page 42) or the channel add/
delete function (page 43)—you will have to tune the RF
channel using the Channel Number and Dash buttons on the
remote control.
The TV will return to the memorized channel one time only.
Once you press CH RTN and then change channels again, the
CH RTN memory will be cleared and the button will function
as Channel Return, by switching back and forth between the last
two channels that were selected.
Channel Numbers
—
(dash)
CHANNEL yz
CH RTN
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
76
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Selecting the picture size
You can view many program formats in a variety of picture
sizes—Natural, TheaterWide 1, TheaterWide 2, TheaterWide 3,
and Full—as described below and on the next page.
Numbers
PIC SIZE
The way the image displays in any of the picture sizes will vary
depending on the format of the program you are viewing. Select
the picture size that displays the current program the way that
looks best to you.
Your picture size preferences can be saved for each input on your
TV.
y
z
To select the picture size:
1. Press PIC SIZE on the remote control.
2. While the Picture Size menu is on-screen, press the
corresponding number button (0–4) to select the desired
picture size.
Note:
Picture Size
You also can select the picture size using the
menu system. Select Picture Size in the
Video/Theater Settings menu. Select the input
you wish to save your picture size settings for.
To save your settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER.
0
1
2
3
4
Natural
TheaterWide 1
TheaterWide 2
TheaterWide 3
Full
0
4
PIC SIZE
to Select
-
/
Note:
Theater Settings
Picture Size
Natural
• You also can repeatedly press PIC SIZE to select the desired
picture size (or press the yz buttons on the remote control
while the Picture Size screen is open).
Picture Scroll
Cinema Mode
Auto Aspect Ratio
--
Film
On
• “Full” may not be available for some program formats (it will
be “grayed out” in the Picture Size screen).
Reset
Done
Natural picture size
• The image is displayed close to its originally formatted
proportion. Some program formats will display with
sidebars and/or bars at the top and bottom.
Natural picture size example: The way the image displays will
vary depending on the format of the program you are currently
watching.
Conventional picture on a
conventional TV screen
Conventional picture in Natural size on
your wide-screen TV
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
77
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Selecting the picture size (continued)
Note:
TheaterWide 1 picture size (For 4:3 format program)
• If you select one of the TheaterWide® picture
sizes, the top and bottom edges of the
picture (including subtitles or captions) may
be hidden. To view the hidden edges, either
scroll the picture (TheaterWide 2 and 3 only)
or try viewing the program in Full or Natural
picture size.
• The center of the picture remains close to its
original proportion, but the left and right
edges are stretched wider to fill the screen.
• When selecting the picture size, the way
the image displays will vary depending on
the format of the program you are
currently watching.
TheaterWide 1 picture size example
Using these functions to change the
picture size (i.e., changing the height/
width ratio) for any purpose other than
your private viewing may be prohibited
under the Copyright Laws of the United
States and other countries, and may
subject you to civil and criminal liability.
TheaterWide 2 picture size (for letter box programs)
• The picture is stretched wider to fill the width
of the screen, but only slightly stretched taller.
• The top and bottom edges of the picture are
A B C D E F G - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
hidden. To view the hidden areas, see
“Scrolling the TheaterWide® picture” on page
74.
TheaterWide 2 picture size example
TheaterWide 3 picture size (for letter box programs with subtitles)
• The picture is stretched wider to fill the width
of the screen, but only slightly stretched taller.
• The top and bottom edges are hidden. To view
A B C D E F G - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
the hidden areas (such as subtitles or captions),
see “Scrolling the TheaterWide® picture” on
page 74.
A B C D E F G - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
TheaterWide 3 picture size example
Full picture size (for 16:9 [480i, 480p] source programs only)
• If receiving a squeezed 4:3 format program, the
picture is stretched wider to fill the width of
the screen, but not stretched taller.
• None of the picture is hidden.
Full picture size example
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
78
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Scrolling the TheaterWide® picture
Using the auto aspect ratio feature
(TheaterWide 2 and 3 only)
When the auto aspect ratio feature is set to On, the picture size
is automatically selected when one of the following input
sources is received:
You can set separate scroll settings for TheaterWide 2 and
TheaterWide 3 modes for each input.
• A 480i signal from the VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3,
ColorStream HD-1, or ColorStream HD-2 input.
To set the scroll settings:
1. Press INPUT on the remote control or TV/VIDEO on the
TV to select the input for which you want to set the picture
size and scroll settings.
• A 1080i, 480i, 480p, or 720p signal from the HDMI input.
Automatic aspect size
Aspect ratio
(automatically selected
of signal source
2. Press MENU and open the Video menu.
when Auto Aspect is On)
3. Highlight Theater Settings and press ENTER.
4:3 normal
4:3 letter box
16:9 full
Natural (with sidebars)
TheaterWide 2
Full
Video
Not defined
(no ID-1 data or )
HDMI aspect data)
Picture Settings
User-selected picture size
Advanced Picture Settings
Theater Settings
(see pages 72–73)
Note:
• The auto aspect ratio feature is not applicable to antenna or Cable input
sources.
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
4. In the Picture Size field, select either TheaterWide 2 or
TheaterWide 3 (you cannot scroll in any other mode).
• The auto aspect ratio feature is not available when the POP double-window
is open, the Freeze mode is active, or the TV Guide On Screen™ system is
open.
5. Press z to highlight the Picture Scroll field.
6. Press x or • to scroll the picture up and down as needed,
To turn on the auto aspect ratio feature:
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.
2. Highlight Theater Settings and press ENTER.
from –10 to +20.
Theater Settings
Picture Size
Theater Wide 2
Picture Scroll
Cinema Mode
Auto Aspect Ratio
-5
Film
On
Video
Picture Settings
Reset
Done
Advanced Picture Settings
Theater Settings
7. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
3. In the Auto Aspect Ratio field, select On.
Theater Settings
Picture Size
Natural
Picture Scroll
Cinema Mode
Auto Aspect Ratio
-1
Film
On
Reset
Done
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
To turn off the auto aspect ratio feature:
Select Off in step 3 above.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
79
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Selecting the cinema mode
(480i signals only)
Selecting the lamp mode
You can select either the High Bright or Low Power lamp mode.
• The High Bright mode is useful when additional picture
brightness is desired (such as in a bright room).
When you view a DVD (480i signal; 3:2 pulldown processed)
from a DVD player connected to the VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2,
ColorStream HD1/HD2 (component video), or HDMI inputs
on the TV, smoother motion can be obtained by setting the
Cinema Mode to Film.
• The Low Power mode reduces wear on the projection lamp.
Using this mode should result in longer lamp life.
See “Lamp unit replacement” on page 103–105.
To set the Cinema Mode to Film:
To select the lamp mode:
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.
2. Highlight Theater Settings and press ENTER.
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.
Video
Video
Picture Settings
Picture Settings
Advanced Picture Settings
Theater Settings
Advanced Picture Settings
Theater Settings
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
3. In the Cinema Mode field, select Film.
3. In the Lamp Mode field, select High Bright or Low Power,
whichever you prefer.
Theater Settings
Picture Size
Natural
Advanced Picture Settings
ANT 1
Picture Scroll
Cinema Mode
Auto Aspect Ratio
-1
Dynamic Contrast
MPEG Noise Reduction
CableClear
On
Low
Film
On
Off
Reset
Done
Color Temperature
Lamp Mode
Medium
Low Power
Color Management
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
Reset
Done
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
To set the Cinema Mode to Video:
Select Video in step 3 above.
Note:
If you set the lamp mode to Low Power, each time you turn on the TV, the
lamp will start out in High Bright mode but will switch to Low Power mode
in approximately 1 minute. You will notice a change in screen brightness
when this happens. This is normal and is not a sign of malfunction.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
80
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Using the POP features
Using the POP double-window feature
The POP (picture-out-picture) double-window feature splits the screen into two
windows so you can watch two programs at the same time.
Note:
• When the main window is in the ANT1 or ANT2
mode, the ANT1 and ANT2 inputs cannot be
selected for the POP window.
To display a program in the POP window:
1. Select the program you want to watch in the main window.
2. Press SPLIT to open the POP double-window.
POP double-window
• When the main window is in Video 1/2/3,
ColorStream HD1/HD2, HDMI 1, or HDMI 2
mode, those inputs cannot be selected for the POP
window.
• You cannot view IEEE1394 source programs in the
POP window.
• You cannot view two video or two antenna sources
in both the main and POP windows simultaneously.
(You can view a video source in one window and
an antenna source in the other.)
POP window
Main window
ANT1
POP
TV12
Video1
• The FREEZE feature is not available when the POP
double-window is open. If you press FREEZE
when the double-window is open, the message
“Not available” will appear.
Green border
(denotes active window)
3. Press • to highlight the POP (right) window. When highlighted, the window
will have a green border.
4. Press INPUT to open the POP Input Selection window. Select the input source
for the POP window by pressing the corresponding Number button (0–9). The
current source displays in purple in the POP Input Selection window.
Numbers
INPUT
POP Input Selection
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
ANT 1
Video 1
•
Video 2
Video 3
ColorStream HD1
ColorStream HD2
HDMI 1
ENTER
HDMI 2
PC
ANT 2
0
9
INPUT
to Select
-
/
SPLIT
To close the POP window and tune to the highlighted window:
Press ENTER after highlighting the window you want to view as a normal picture.
To close the POP window:
Press SPLIT or EXIT.
Notes about recording:
• If the POP window is open and you attempt to start recording, the POP window will close and
recording will start.
• If you use the TV’s remote control to start recording, you will not be able to open the POP window
and the message “Not Available” will appear on-screen.
• It is recommended that you use the TV’s remote control to start recording. If you use a device other
than the TV’s remote control to start recording, you may be able to open the POP window during
the recording process. If this happens, the recorded audio will reflect the audio of the active window
(main or POP), which may not be the audio you intended to record.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
81
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Using the POP features (continued)
Switching the speaker audio (main or POP)
While the POP window is open, press x or • to switch the sound (main or POP) that
is output from the TV speakers (and from the VARIABLE AUDIO OUT terminals).
The window with the active sound is outlined with a green border.
Example: Press x
Example: Press •
x •
POP double-window aspect ratio
The POP double-window feature displays each picture according to its input signal
aspect ratio, as illustrated in the examples below.
480i
480i
480p/720p/1080i
480i
Note:
• The auto aspect ratio feature (page xx) does not
operate in POP double-window mode.
• Aspect ratio is the ratio of width to height of the
picture.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
82
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Using the FREEZE feature
1. When viewing the TV, press FREEZE to make the picture a still picture.
2. To return to the moving picture, either press FREEZE again, press EXIT, or press
any other button.
Using the FREEZE function for any
purpose other than your private viewing
may be prohibited under the Copyright
Laws of the United States and other
countries, and may subject you to civil
and criminal liability.
Note:
• The FREEZE feature is not available when the POP double-window or FAV SCAN
multi-window is open. If you press FREEZE when either window is open, the message
“Not available” will appear.
• If the TV is left in FREEZE mode, after 15 minutes it will automatically release the
FREEZE mode and return to the moving picture.
y
x
•
z
ENTER
EXIT
Moving picture
Still picture
Using the favorite channel scan feature
FREEZE
You can use this feature to quickly scan and tune the channels you programmed as
favorite channels from a nine-picture multi-window.
FAV SCAN
Note: To use the favorite channel scan feature, you must first program channels into the
favorite channel memory. See “Programming your favorite channels” on page 44.
To scan and tune your favorite channels:
1. Press FAV SCAN. The TV will display the channels you programmed as favorite
channels for the current ANT input in a nine-picture multi-window.
(To display the channels you programmed as favorite channels for the other input,
you must change antenna inputs first (page 67), and then press FAV SCAN.)
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
2
4–1
11
4–2
13
6
CABLE
18
18
31
36
2. Highlight the window for the channel you want to view:
• Either... press the channel’s multi-window position number (1-9, as illustrated
above, and not the actual channel number) to highlight the window;
• or... use the y z x • buttons to highlight the window.
The highlighted window will display as a moving picture.
3. Press ENTER to tune the TV to the highlighted channel and close the multi-window.
2
4–1
11
4–2
13
6
18
31
36
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
83
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Adjusting the picture
Selecting the picture mode
Adjusting the picture quality
You can select your desired picture settings from four picture
modes, as described below.
You can adjust the picture quality (contrast, brightness, color,
tint, and sharpness) to your personal preferences.
Mode
Picture Quality
Selection
x Pressing •
Sports
Standard
Movie
Bright and dynamic picture (factory setting)
Standard picture settings (factory setting)
Lower contrast for darkened room (factory setting)
contrast
brightness
color
tint
sharpness
lower
darker
paler
reddish
softer
higher
lighter
deeper
greenish
sharper
Preference Your personal preferences
To select the picture mode:
To adjust the picture quality:
Press PIC MODE on the remote control.
The following popup menu appears on-
screen.
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.
2. Highlight Picture Settings and press ENTER.
Picture Settings
Mode: Standard
Standard
Mode
Video
Repeatedly press PIC MODE to cycle
among the modes or use x or • to
select the modes.
Picture Settings
PIC
MODE
Advanced Picture Settings
Theater Settings
3. Press y or z to select the picture quality you want to adjust
(Contrast, Brightness, Color, Tint, or Sharpness), and then
x and • to adjust the setting, as described in the table
above.
To select the picture mode using the menu system:
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.
2. Highlight Picture Settings and press ENTER.
Picture Settings
ANT 1
Mode
Sports
Contrast
Brightness
Color
100
50
50
0
Video
Picture Settings
Advanced Picture Settings
Theater Settings
Tint
Sharpness
50
Reset
Done
3. In the Mode field, select the mode you prefer.
Picture Settings
Mode: Preference
Sharpness
70
Picture Settings
ANT 1
Mode
Sports
Contrast
Brightness
Color
100
50
50
0
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
Tint
Sharpness
50
Reset
Done
The picture qualities you adjusted are automatically saved in the
Preference mode (see “Selecting the picture mode,” above left).
Picture Settings
Mode: Standard
Standard
Mode
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
Note:
• The picture mode you selected is for the current input
selection only (ANT 1 in the example above). You can select
a different picture mode for each input selection.
• If you select one of the factory-set picture modes (Sports,
Standard, or Movie) and then change a picture quality setting
(for example, increase the contrast or change the color
temperature), the picture mode automatically changes to
Preference in the Picture Settings menu.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
84
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Adjusting the picture (continued)
7. Press Enter to return to the Color Management Window.
Using the Color Management feature
The Color management feature allows you to adjust the hue and
saturation of 6 colors: red, green, blue, yellow, magenta, and
cyan.
8. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
Note:
To select Color Management preferences:
• If you select Off in step 4 above, you cannot adjust the Hue or
Saturation.
1. Press Menu and open the Video menu.
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.
• If you select one of the factory-set picture modes (Sports,
Standard, or Movie) and then change the Color Management
to “On”, the picture mode automatically changes to
Preference in the Picture Settings menu.
Video
Picture Settings
Advanced Picture Settings
Theater Settings
3. In the Color Management field, and press ENTER.
Advanced Picture Settings
ANT 1
Dynamic Contrast
MPEG Noise Reduction
CableClear
On
Low
Auto
Color Temperature
Lamp Mode
Cool
Low Power
Color Management
Reset
Done
4. Highlight Color Management, and then press x or • to
select On.
Color Management
Color Managemant
On
Hue
–15
Saturation
+15
Red
Green
Blue
0
–15
0
0
+15
0
Yellow
Magenta
Cyan
–15
0
+15
0
Reset
Done
5. Press y or z to highlight the color you want to adjust,
then press ENTER.
6. Press x or • to adjust the Hue or Saturation setting.
Hue
+2
+2
Saturation
Note: Pressing y or z will switch between the Hue and
Saturation adjusting windows.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
85
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Adjusting the picture (continued)
Using CableClear® /DNR (digital noise
reduction)
The CableClear® digital noise reduction feature allows you to
reduce visible interference in your TV picture. This may be
useful when receiving a broadcast with a weak signal (especially
a Cable channel) or playing a noisy video cassette or disc. This
feature is enabled for 480i signals only.
Selecting the color temperature
You can change the quality of the picture by selecting from three
preset color temperatures (cool, medium, and warm), as
described below.
Mode
Picture Quality
cool
blueish
medium neutral
warm reddish
Note: The CableClear DNR feature does not function in
ColorStream, HDMI (DVI), ATSC, IEEE1394, and digital Cable
modes.
To select the color temperature:
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.
To select CableClear/DNR preferences:
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.
Video
Picture Settings
AdvancedPictureSettings
Theater Settings
Video
Picture Settings
Advanced Picture Settings
Theater Settings
3. In the Color Temperature field, select the mode you prefer
(Cool, Medium, or Warm).
3. In the CableClear/DNR field, select your desired setting.
Advanced Picture Settings
ANT 1
Advanced Picture Settings
ANT 1
Dynamic Contrast
MPEG Noise Reduction
CableClear
On
Low
Dynamic Contrast
MPEG Noise Reduction
CableClear
On
Low
Auto
Auto
Color Temperature
Lamp Mode
Cool
Color Temperature
Lamp Mode
Cool
Low Power
Low Power
Color Management
Color Management
Reset
Done
Reset
Done
Note:
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
• If the current input is Antenna, Video 1, Video 2, or Video 3,
the menu will display the text CableClear. The available
selections are Off, Low, Middle, High, and Auto.
Note:
• If the current input is ColorStream HD1, ColorStream HD2, or
HDMI, and the video resolution is 480i, the menu will display
the text “DNR.” The available selections are Off, Low, Middle,
High, and Auto. Auto will react proportionally to the strength of
the noise. Low, Middle, and High, will reduce the noise in
varying degrees from lowest to highest, respectively.
If you select one of the factory-set picture modes (Sports,
Standard, or Movie) and then change the color temperature
mode, the picture mode automatically changes to Preference in
the Picture Settings menu.
• If the current input is ColorStream HD1, ColorStream HD2, or
HDMI, and the video resolution is not 480i, the menu will
display the text “DNR”.
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
86
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Adjusting the picture (continued)
Using MPEG noise reduction
Using dynamic contrast
The MPEG noise reduction feature allows you to reduce visible
interference caused by MPEG compression. Choices for MPEG
noise reduction are High, Medium, Low and Off. Off is
automatically selected when this feature is disabled (“grayed
out”). This feature is not available in the PC input mode.
When dynamic contrast is set to “On,” the TV will detect
changes in the picture quality that affect the appearance of your
contrast settings and automatically adjust the video.When
dynamic contrast is set to “Off,” the settings selected in the
Contrast field in Picture Settings will be used.
To select MPEG Noise Reduction preferences:
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.
To select dynamic contrast preferences:
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.
Video
Video
Picture Settings
Picture Settings
Advanced Picture Settings
Theater Settings
Advanced Picture Settings
Theater Settings
3. In the MPEG Noise Reduction field, select your desired
setting.
3. In the Dynamic Contrast field, select either On or Off.
Advanced Picture Settings
ANT 1
Dynamic Contrast
MPEG Noise Reduction
CableClear
On
Low
Advanced Picture Settings
ANT 1
Dynamic Contrast
MPEG Noise Reduction
CableClear
On
Low
Auto
Color Temperature
Lamp Mode
Cool
Auto
Low Power
Color Temperature
Lamp Mode
Cool
Color Management
Low Power
Color Management
Reset
Done
Reset
Done
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
Note:
If you select one of the factory-set picture modes (Sports,
Standard, or Movie) and then change the dynamic contrast to
“On,” the picture mode automatically changes to Preference in
the Picture Settings menu.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
87
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Using the closed caption mode
The closed caption mode has two options:
Advanced closed captions
You can customize the closed caption display characteristics by
changing the text size, type, edge, color, and the background
color.
• Captions—An on-screen display of the dialogue, narration,
and sound effects of TV programs and videos that are
closed captioned (usually marked “CC” in program guides).
• Text—An on-screen display of information not related to
the current program, such as weather or stock data (when
provided by individual stations).
Note:
• This feature is available for digital channels only.
• You cannot set the Caption Text and Background as the same
color.
To view captions or text:
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.
2. Highlight Closed Caption Mode and then press •.
To customize the closed captions:
1. Press MENU and open
3. Press z or y to select the desired closed caption mode and
the Preferences menu.
Preferences
press ENTER.
Favorite Channels
2. Highlight Closed
Closed Caption Mode
CC1
Caption Advanced and
press ENTER.
Closed Caption Advanced
Input Labeling
Preferences
English
Menu Language
Home CH Setup
Favorite Channels
Closed Caption Mode
Closed Caption Advanced
Input Labeling
Off
CC1
CC2
CC3
CC4
T1
3. Press y or z to
highlight the
Off
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
English
Menu Language
Home CH Setup
characteristic you want
to change, and then
T2
press x or • to select the format for that characteristic.
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
4. To save the
Advanced Closed Captions
• To view captions:
Highlight CC1,
CC2, CC3, or
CC4. (CC1 displays
translation of the
primary language in
your area.)
new settings,
Caption Size
Auto
Auto
Auto
Auto
Auto
Caption Text Type
Caption Text Edge
Caption Text Color
Background Color
highlight
Done and
press
ENTER. To
revert to the
factory
Reset
Done
Giant pandas eat leaves.
defaults, highlight Reset and press ENTER.
Note: If the
program or video
you selected is not closed captioned, no captions will display
on-screen.
Caption Size
Auto, Small, Standard, Large
Caption Text Type
Auto, Default, Mono w. Serif, Prof. w. Serif,
Mono w/o Serif, Prop w/o Serif, Casual,
Cursive, Small Capitals
• To view text:
Highlight T1, T2,
T3, or T4.
Caption Text Edge Auto, None, Raised, Depressed, Uniform,
Left Drop Shadow, Right Drop shadow
Note: If text is not
available in your
area, a black
rectangle may
appear on your
screen. If this
WORLD WEATHER
Temps
Current
Weather
Clear
Cloudy
Clear
F
C
Caption Text Color Auto, Black, White, Red, Green, Blue,
Yellow, Magenta, Cyan
LONDON
MOSCOW
PARIS
51
57
53
66
65
11
14
12
19
18
ROME
TOKYO
Cloudy
Rain
Auto, Black, White, Red, Green, Blue,
Yellow, Magenta, Cyan
Background Color
happens, turn the Closed Caption Mode Off.
• To turn off the Closed Caption mode:
Select Off in step 3 above.
Note: You cannot set the Caption Text and Background as the
same color.
Note: A closed caption signal may not display in the following situations:
• When a videotape has been dubbed
• When the signal reception is weak
• When the signal reception is non-standard
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
88
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Using the closed caption mode (continued)
Digital closed captions
You can use the Digital CC/Audio selector to select digital
closed caption services (if available), which will temporarily
override closed captions for digital channels only.
When such services are not available, the Digital CC/Audio
selector presents a default list of services. If the selected service is
not available, the next best service will be used instead.
To select digital closed captions:
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.
2. Highlight Digital CC/Audio Selector and press ENTER.
Applications
TV Guide On Screen
Audio Player
Picture Viewer
Digital CC/Audio Selector
CableCARD
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
3. Press y or z to select Closed Caption, and then press x or
• to select the desired service.
Audio
CC 1
Service 1
Closed Caption
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
89
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Adjusting the audio
Muting the sound
Press MUTE to partially reduce (1/2 Mute) or turn off (Mute)
the sound. Each time you press MUTE, the mute mode will
change in the following order.
Selecting stereo/SAP broadcasts
The multi-channel TV sound (MTS) feature allows you to
output high-fidelity stereo sound. MTS also can transmit a
second audio program (SAP) containing a second language,
music, or other audio information (when provided by individual
stations).
→ 1/2 Mute → Mute → Volume →
If the closed caption mode is set to Off when you select
“MUTE” mode, the closed caption feature is automatically
activated. To mute the audio without automatically activating
the closed caption feature, use the VOL z button to set the
volume to 0. See “Using the closed caption mode” on page 82
for more information on closed caption modes.
The MTS feature is not available when the TV is in VIDEO
mode. When the TV receives a stereo or SAP broadcast, the
word “STEREO” or “SAP” appears on-screen when RECALL is
pressed.
To listen to stereo sound:
1. Press MENU and open
the Audio menu.
Audio
2. Highlight Audio Setup
and press ENTER.
Audio Settings
Advanced Audio Settings
Audio Setup
VOL z
RECALL
MUTE
Audio Setup
3. In the MTS field, select
Stereo.
MTS
Stereo
English
Language
Speakers
On
Optical Output Format
Dolby Digital
Using the digital audio selector
Reset
Done
You can use the Digital CC/Audio selector to conveniently
switch between audio tracks on a digital channel (for those
channels that have multiple audio tracks). This temporarily
overrides the audio track chosen by the language option under
Audio Setup.
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To reset the settings to the factory defaults,
highlight Reset and press ENTER.
Note:
• You can leave the TV in Stereo mode because it automatically
outputs the type of sound being broadcast (stereo or monaural).
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.
2. Highlight Digital CC/
• If the stereo sound is noisy, select MONO to reduce the noise.
Audio Selector and press
ENTER.
Applications
To listen to an alternate language on an ATSC digital station
(if available):
TV Guide On Screen
Audio Player
3. Press y or z to select
Picture Viewer
Highlight the Language field in step 3 above, and then press x
or • to select the language you prefer.
Digital CC/Audio Selector
Audio, and then press x
or • to select the desired
CableCARD
service.
To listen to a second audio program on an analog station (if
available):
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Select SAP in step 3 above.
Audio
CC 1
Service 1
Closed Caption
Note:
• A second audio program (SAP) can be heard only on those TV
stations that offer it. For example, a station might broadcast another
language as a second audio program. If you have SAP on, you will
see the current program on the screen but hear the other language
instead of the program’s normal audio.
• If you have SAP on and the station you are watching is not
broadcasting a second audio program, the station’s normal audio
will be output. However, occasionally there is no sound at all in SAP
mode. If this happens, set the MTS feature to Stereo mode.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
90
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Adjusting the audio (continued)
Adjusting the audio quality
You can adjust the audio quality by adjusting the bass, treble,
and balance.
5. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To reset the settings to the factory defaults,
highlight Reset and press ENTER.
To turn off the SBS:
To adjust the audio quality:
Select Off in step 3.
1. Press MENU and open the Audio menu.
2. Highlight Audio Settings and press ENTER.
Using the StableSound® feature
The StableSound® feature limits the highest volume level to
prevent extreme changes in volume when the signal source
changes (for example, to prevent the sudden increase in volume
that often happens when a TV program switches to a
commercial).
Audio
Audio Settings
Advanced Audio Settings
Audio Setup
To turn on the StableSound® feature:
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
1. Press MENU and open the Audio menu.
2. Highlight Audio Settings and press ENTER.
3. Press zor y to highlight the item you want to adjust (Bass,
Treble, or Balance).
Audio Settings
Audio
Bass
100
100
0
Audio Settings
Treble
Advanced Audio Settings
Audio Setup
Balance
SBS
On
Off
SBS Level
StableSound
85
Reset
Done
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
4. Press x or • to adjust the level.
3. In the StableSound field, select On.
• x makes the bass or treble weaker or increases the balance
Audio Settings
in the left channel (depending on the item selected).
Bass
100
100
0
Treble
Balance
SBS
• • makes the bass or treble stronger or increases the balance
On
in the right channel (depending on the item selected).
SBS Level
StableSound
85
Off
5. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To reset the settings to the factory defaults,
highlight Reset and press ENTER.
Reset
Done
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To reset the settings to the factory defaults,
highlight Reset and press ENTER.
Using the sub-bass system (SBS)
The sub-bass system allows you to enhance bass performance,
even when the volume is low.
Note: The RESET function returns your audio adjustments to
the following factory settings:
Bass ............. center (50)
Treble .......... center (50)
Balance ........ center (0)
StableSound... Off
To turn on the SBS and adjust the level:
1. Press MENU and open the Audio menu.
2. Highlight Audio settings and press ENTER.
3. In the SBS field, select On.
To turn off the StableSound feature:
4. Press y or z to highlight SBS Level, and then press x or •
Select Off in step 3 above.
to adjust the sub-bass system.
Audio Settings
Bass
100
100
0
Treble
Balance
SBS
On
Off
SBS Level
StableSound
85
Reset
Done
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
91
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Adjusting the audio (continued)
Using the SRS WOW™ surround sound
feature
WOW™ is a special combination of SRS Labs audio
technologies (SRS 3D, FOCUS, and TruBass) that creates a
thrilling surround sound experience with deep, rich bass from
stereo sound sources. Your TV’s audio will sound fuller, richer,
and wider.
Using the Dolby Virtual with SRS
TruSurround sound feature
The Dolby® Virtual surround sound feature allows you to enjoy
virtual surround sound from the TV’s speakers.
• If you connect a device (a game console, a DVD player or
a DTV receiver, etc.) with analog audio output to the
standard (analog) audio terminals on the TV, and the input
source is encoded with Dolby Surround
Dolby Digital sound, the Dolby Virtual feature
operates as Virtual Dolby Surround (VDS). VDS
To adjust the WOW™ settings:
sound or
1. Put the TV in STEREO mode (see “Selecting stereo/SAP
broadcasts” on page 84).
2. Press MENU and open the Audio menu.
simulates Dolby Surround sound from the TV’s speakers.
3. Highlight Advanced Audio Settings and press ENTER.
To turn on the Dolby Virtual surround sound feature:
1. Press MENU and open the Audio menu.
Audio
2. Highlight Advanced Audio Settings and press ENTER.
Audio Settings
Advanced Audio Settings
Audio Setup
Audio
Audio Settings
4. Press z or y to highlight the WOW feature you want to
Advanced Audio Settings
Audio Setup
adjust, and then press x or • to adjust the item.
Advanced Audio Settings
3. Press y or z to highlight the Dolby Virtual TruSurround,
WOW: SRS 3D
WOW: FOCUS
WOW: TruBass
Off
Off
and then press x or • to select On.
Low
Advanced Audio Settings
Dolby Virtual
TruSurround
On
WOW: SRS 3D
WOW: FOCUS
WOW: TruBass
Off
Off
Low
Reset
Done
Dolby Virtual
TruSurround
On
• WOW: SRS 3D — To turn the surround sound effect On
or Off.
Reset
Done
Note: If the broadcast is monaural, the 3D effect does not
work.
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
• WOW: Focus — To turn the vocal emphasis effect On or
Off.
To turn off the Dolby Virtual surround sound feature:
• WOW: TruBass — To select the desired bass expansion
level (High, Low, or Off).
Select Off in step 3 above.
Note:
5. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
• The Dolby Virtual TruSurround and WOW SRS 3D features cannot
be on at the same time. If you set one to On, the other will
automatically be set to Off.
• The Dolby Virtual TruSurround feature is enabled only when
receiving digital broadcasts.
• WOW, TruSurround, SRS and
symbol are trademarks of SRS Labs, Inc.
WOW technology is incorporated under license from SRS Labs, Inc.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
92
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Adjusting the audio (continued)
Turning off the built-in speakers
Use this feature to turn off the TV speakers when you connect
an audio system to your TV (see “Connecting a digital audio
system” and “Connecting an analog audio system” on page 20).
To turn off the built-in speakers:
1. Press MENU and open
the Audio menu.
Audio
2. Highlight Audio Setup
Audio Settings
Advanced Audio Settings
and press ENTER.
Audio Setup
Audio Setup
3. In the Speakers field,
MTS
Stereo
English
select Off.
Language
Speakers
On
Optical Output Format
Dolby Digital
Reset
Done
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
To turn on the built-in speakers:
Select On in step 3 above.
Selecting the optical audio output
format
Use this feature to select the optical audio output format when
you connect a Dolby Digital decoder or other digital audio
system to the Optical Audio Out terminal on the TV (see
“Connecting a digital audio system” on page 20).
To select the optical audio output format:
1. Press MENU and open
the Audio menu.
Audio
2. Highlight Audio Setup
Audio Settings
Advanced Audio Settings
and press ENTER.
Audio Setup
Audio Setup
3. In the Optical Output
MTS
Stereo
English
Format field, select either
Dolby Digital or PCM,
depending on your
device.
Language
Speakers
On
Optical Output Format
Dolby Digital
Reset
Done
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset
and press ENTER.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
93
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Setting the On/Off Timer
Setting the sleep timer
You can use the On/Off Timer to turn the TV on and off at a
preset time on a recurring basis.
Note: You must first set the time (see page 50).
You can set the sleep timer to turn off the TV after a set length
of time (maximum of 3 hours). The sleep timer turns off the TV
one time only, as opposed to the On/Off Timer, which turns off
the TV on a recurring basis.
To set the On/Off Timer:
To set the sleep timer:
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight On/Off Timer and press ENTER.
Press SLEEP on the remote control to set the length of time until
the TV turns off. Repeatedly press SLEEP to increase the time in
10-minute increments or press y or z to increase or decrease the
time in 10-minute increments, to a maximum of 3 hours and 00
minutes.
Setup
Installation
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
To cancel the sleep timer:
HDMI 1 Audio
Auto
Auto
Press SLEEP until it is set to 0.
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
2 Sec
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
SLEEP
3. In the DAY field, press x or • to select the recurrence
(weekends, weekdays, Every day, etc).
To set the sleep timer using the on-screen menus:
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight Sleep Timer and press ENTER.
On/Off Timer
Turn TV ON:
Day
Weekends
9 : 0 AM
30 Minutes
0
0
Time (HH:MM)
TV ON Duration:
Reset
Cancel
Done
Setup
Installation
4. Press z to highlight the Time field, and then use the
Number buttons to enter the time you want the TV to turn
on.
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
HDMI 1 Audio
Auto
Auto
HDMI 2 Audio
5. When the AM/PM field is highlighted, press • to select
Slide Show Interval
2 Sec
AM or PM.
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
6. Press z to highlight the TV ON Duration field, and then
press x or • to select the length of time until the TV turns
off.
3. Press the Number buttons to enter the length of time in
10-minute increments.
Sleep Timer
7. Highlight Done and press ENTER.
Enter total minutes until the TV
turns off automatically (Maximum
180 minutes)
8. Turn off the TV. The TV will turn on automatically on the
day(s) and at the time you set. The TV will then turn off
automatically after the length of time you set in the TV
ON Duration field.
1 2 0
Cancel
Done
Note:
• When a power failure occurs, the On/Off Timer settings may
be cleared.
4. Highlight Done and press ENTER.
Note:
• To display the On Timer setting, press RECALL.
• When a power failure occurs, the sleep timer setting may be cleared.
• To display the amount of time left on the sleep timer, press RECALL.
To turn off the On/Off Timer:
Select Not Set in step 3 above.
To display the remaining sleep time:
Press SLEEP.
On/Off Timer
Turn TV ON:
Sleep Timer
Day
Not Set
1h10m
Note:
Reset
Cancel
Done
A message will display on-screen when there is one minute
remaining on the sleep timer.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
94
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Using the PC setting feature
You can adjust the horizontal position/size, vertical position/size,
clock phase, and sampling clock. This feature will be grayed out
on the menu unless there is a PC connected to the TV (See
“Connecting a personal computer (PC)” on page 29.)
To set the PC setting:
1. Confirm a PC is connected (see “Connecting a personal
computer (PC)” on page 29).
2. Repeatedly press INPUT to select PC input mode. (See
Selecting the video input source to view ” on page 72.)
3. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
4. Highlight PC Settings and press ENTER.
Setup
Installation
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
HDMI 1 Audio
Auto
Auto
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
2 Sec
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
5. Press y or z to highlight the item you want to adjust.
6. Press x or • to make the appropriate adjustments.
PC Settings
Horizontal Position
Horizontal Width
Vertical Position
Vertical Height
Clock Phase
0
0
0
0
0
0
Sampling Clock
Reset
Done
• Horizontal Position/Vertical Position:
Adjusts picture left/right and up/down. The adjustment range
is within 5 from center.
(The adjustable range may vary depending on the input mode.)
• Horizontal Width/Vertical Hegiht:
Adjusts picture width of Horizontal and picture height of Vertical.
The adjustment range is within 5 from center.
• Clock Phase:
This function is to reduce noise and sharpen the picture.
The adjustment range is within 15 from center.
• Sampling Clock:
This function is to minimize periodic vertical stripes on the
screen.
The adjustment range is within 15 from center.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
95
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features
Displaying the Channel Banner
Understanding the auto power off
feature
To display the channel banner:
Press RECALL on the remote control.
The TV will automatically turn itself off after approximately 15
minutes if it is tuned to a vacant channel or a station that
completes its broadcast for the day. This feature functions in
ANT 1 and ANT 2 modes only.
The following information will display in the channel banner
(if applicable):
• Current input (ANT 1, ANT 2, VIDEO 1, etc.)
• If ANT 1 or ANT 2 is the current input, whether it is
STEREO
Tuner Hold: On
Cable TV (“CABLE”) or
off-air (“TV”)
NC-17
Understanding the last mode
memory feature
• Channel number (if in
ANT 1 or ANT 2 mode)
On Timer: Weekdays 12:00pm
Sleep Timer: 18 min.
Game Timer: 28 min.
ANT 1
• Signal strength indicator
(bar graph in lower right
corner of banner; for
ATSC signal only)
Natural
5:32pm
1080i
CABLE 81-1
If the power is cut off while you are viewing the TV, the Last
Mode Memory feature automatically turns on the TV when
the power is resupplied.
Sample channel banner screen
Note: The signal strength indicator will react to fading and
increasing signals and could display longer than the normal
channel banner screen.
Note: You should unplug the TV’s power cord if it is possible
that you will be away from the TV for an extended period of time
after the power is restored.
• Time (if set)
• On/Off timer settings (if set)
• Remaining time on sleep timer (if set)
• Remaining time on game timer (if set)
• Stereo or SAP audio status
• V-Chip rating status
Using the Gray Level feature
The gray level feature will set the sidebars to three different
levels of darkness. Sidebars are the blanks spaces on either side
of a 4:3 viewing area.
• Picture size
• Tuner hold* (if applicable)
To set the gray level of the sidebars:
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight Gray Level and press •.
*If you are recording on one tuner (for example, the digital
tuner), you will be able to change channels on the other tuner
only (the analog tuner in this example). The tuner from which
you are recording is “on hold” (i.e., locked) so your
3. Press y or z to select your desired level of darkness
recordings will not be affected by channel changes.
(1 – Black, 2 – Dark Gray or 3 – Gray).
• Aspect ratio
• Lamp mode (appears only if the TV is in Hi Bright mode)
Setup
To close the channel banner:
PC Settings
1
2
3
Press RECALL again.
Auto
HDMI 1 Audio
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
AVHD Skip Time
Gray Level
Auto
2 Sec
15 min
2
On
Quick Restart
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Note:
• The gray level feature does not affect video being viewed in 16:9
aspect ratio.
• When receiving a signal that has sidebars (e.g., 4:3 aspect ratio
video over a 1080i or 720p signal), the gray level feature will not be
applied to the sidebars.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
96
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the Locks menu
9
The Locks menu includes the Enable Rating Blocking, Edit Rating Limits, Channels Block, Input Lock, Panel Lock, Game Timer,
and New PIN Code features. You can use these features after entering the correct PIN code.
Entering the PIN code
If you cannot remember your
PIN code
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.
While the PIN code entering screen is displayed, press RECALL
four times within five seconds. The PIN code will be cleared and
you can enter a new PIN code.
Locks
Enable Rating Blocking
Edit Rating Limits
Channels Block
Input Lock
Off
Off
Off
Off
Front Panel Lock
Game Timer
New PIN Code
Changing your PIN code
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.
2. Press z to display the PIN code entering screen.
3. Enter your four-digit PIN code and press ENTER.
4. Press z to highlight New PIN Code and press ENTER.
2. Press z, which displays the PIN code entry screen.
• The Lock System screen (below) appears if a PIN code has
not been stored. Press the Channel Number buttons to
enter a new four-digit code, enter the code a second time to
confirm, and press ENTER.
Lock System
Locks
Enable Rating Blocking
Edit Rating Limits
Channels Block
Input Lock
Off
Please enter a 4 digit PIN code
Off
Off
Off
Confirm PIN code
Front Panel Lock
Game Timer
New PIN Code
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Cancel
Done
5. Press the Number buttons to enter a new four-digit code.
Retype the numbers to confirm the PIN code you entered.
6. Press ENTER. The new PIN code is now active.
• The Locks/Active screen (below) appears if the PIN code is
already stored. Press the Channel Number buttons to enter
your four-digit code and press ENTER.
New PIN Code
Locks
Active
Please enter a 4 digit PIN code
Please enter the 4 digit PIN code
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Confirm PIN code
*
*
*
*
Cancel
Done
Cancel
Done
If the wrong PIN code is entered, the message “Incorrect PIN
code, please try again!” appears. Highlight Retry and press
ENTER. Enter the code again and press ENTER.
When the correct PIN code is entered, the Locks menu opens.
Locks
Enable Rating Blocking
Edit Rating Limits
Channels Block
Input Lock
Off
Off
Off
Off
Front Panel Lock
Game Timer
New PIN Code
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
97
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 9: Using the Locks menu
Blocking TV programs and movies by rating (V-Chip)
Some TV programs and movies include signals that classify the
Independent rating system for broadcasters
content of the program (violence, sex, dialog, language). The
V-Chip feature in this TV detects the signals and blocks the
programs according to the ratings you select. (See the tables at
right for rating descriptions.)
Ratings
Description and Content themes
TV-MA Mature Audience Only (This program is specifically designed
to be viewed by adults and therefore may be unsuitable for
children under 17.)
Note: Rating blocking is a function of the V-Chip feature in this
TV, which supports the U.S. V-Chip system only.
L) Crude or indecent language S) Explicit sexual activity
V) Graphic violence
TV-14 Parents Strongly Cautioned (This program contains some
material that many parents would find unsuitable for children
under 14 years of age.)
To block and unblock TV programs and movies:
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.
2. Press z to display the PIN code entering screen.
3. Enter your four-digit PIN code and press ENTER.
4. Press z to highlight Enable Rating Blocking.
D) Intensely suggestive dialog L) Strong, coarse language
S) Intense sexual situations V) Intense violence
TV-PG Parental Guidance Suggested (This program contains
material parents may find unsuitable for younger children.)
D) Some suggestive dialog L) Infrequent coarse language
S) Some sexual situations V) Moderate violence
5. Press • and then z to select On, and then press ENTER.
TV-G
General Audience (Most parents would find this program
suitable for all ages.)
Locks
Enable Rating Blocking
Edit Rating Limits
Channels Block
Input Lock
Off
Off
TV-Y7, Directed to Older Children (This program is designed
TV-Y7FV for children age 7 and above. Note: Programs in which
fantasy violence may be more intense or more combative
than other programs in this category are designated Y7FV.)
On
Off
Off
Off
Front Panel Lock
Game Timer
New PIN Code
TV-Y
All Children (This program is designed to be appropriate for
all children.)
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
6. Press z to highlight Edit Rating Limits and press ENTER.
Independent rating system for movies
Locks
Enable Rating Blocking
Edit Rating Limits
Channels Block
Input Lock
Off
Rating
Description and content themes
X-rated (For adults only)
X
Off
Off
Off
Front Panel Lock
Game Timer
NC-17 Not intended for anyone 17 and under
Restricted (Under 17 requires accompanying parent or adult)
New PIN Code
R
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
PG-13 Parents Strongly Cautioned (Some material may be
inappropriate for children under 13)
The Edit Rating Limits screen (below) appears.
PG
G
Parental Guidance Suggested (Some material may not be
suitable for children)
7. Press yzx • and then press ENTER to select the level of
blocking you prefer. A box with an “×” is a rating that will
be blocked. As you highlight a rating, a definition for the
rating appears at the bottom of the screen. See notes at
right.
General Audience (Appropriate for all ages)
Note:
8. When done selecting the ratings you want to block,
highlight Done and press ENTER.
• If you place an “×” in the box next to “None” Rated or “No Rating,”
programs rated “None” or “No Rating” will be blocked. However, if
the program does not provide any rating information, nothing will be
displayed in the banner and ratings blocking will not take effect.
Edit Rating Limits
Movies
G
TV (V-CHIP) FV
TV-Y
D
L
S
V
Children
Youth
• To display the rating of the program you are watching, press
RECALL on the remote control. If it is not rated, the word “NONE”
appears.
TV-Y7
TV-G
PG
PG-13
R
TV-PG
TV-14
TV-MA
NC-17
X
Cancel
Done
TV –PG
L
V
NONE
"None" Rated or "No Rating"
This program is designed for children age
7
and adove.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
98
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 9: Using the Locks menu
Blocking channels
Unlocking programs temporarily
With the Channels Block feature, you can block specific
channels. You will not be able to tune blocked channels unless
you clear the setting first.
If you try to watch a TV program that exceeds the rating limits
you set, the TV enters program lock mode. You can either
unlock the program temporarily or select a non-locked program
to watch.
To block channels:
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.
2. Press z to display the
PIN code entering
screen.
Locks
To temporarily unlock the program:
Enable Rating Blocking
Edit Rating Limits
Channels Block
Input Lock
Off
1. Press MUTE.
3. Enter your four-digit
PIN code and press
ENTER (see page 93 for
details).
Off
Off
Off
2. Enter your four-digit PIN code and press ENTER. If the
correct code is entered,
Front Panel Lock
Game Timer
Locks
Active
New PIN Code
the program lock mode
is released and the
Enter PIN code to temporaily un-
block.
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
4. Press z to highlight
normal picture appears.
All locking is disabled
until the TV is turned
off, and will be enabled
when the TV is turned on again.
Channels Block and then press ENTER.
*
*
*
*
5. Using the yz x • buttons, select the input for which you
want to change the rating limits (ANT1, ANT2, or Cable
Box, if connected) and press ENTER.
Cancel
Done
A list of the channels available for that input will be
displayed along with the call letters for each channel, if
available.
Locking video inputs
Channels Block
ANT 1
6. Press yz to highlight
the channel you want to
block, then press
You can use the Input Lock feature to lock the video input
sources (VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3, ColorStream HD-1,
ColorStream HD-2, HDMI 1/HDMI 2, PC) and channels 3
and 4. You will not be able to view the input sources or channels
until you turn off the input lock.
1
2
ANT 1
ANT 2
3
Cable Box
ENTER, which puts an
“×” in the box next to
that channel.
4
5
6
7
Allow All
Block All
Cancel
Done
8
7. Repeat step 6 for other
channels you want to
block.
To lock the video inputs:
9
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.
2. Press z to display the PIN code entering screen.
3. Enter your four-digit PIN code and press ENTER.
4. Press z to highlight Input Lock and press •.
10
8. Highlight Done and press ENTER.
To unblock individual channels:
In step 6 above, press yz to highlight the channel you want to
unblock, and then press ENTER to remove the “×” from the
box, and highlight Done, and then press ENTER.
5. Press y or z to select the level of video input locking you
prefer, as described below:
Video: Locks VIDEO 1,
To block all channels at once:
VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3,
Locks
Highlight Block All in step 6 above, and then highlight Done,
and press ENTER.
ColorStream HD1/
HD2, HDMI 1/
HDMI 2, and PC.
Enable Rating Blocking
Edit Rating Limits
Channels Block
Input Lock
Off
Off
Video
Video +
Off
Off
Off
To unblock all locked channels at once:
Front Panel Lock
Game Timer
Video+: Locks VIDEO
1, VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3,
ColorStream HD1/
HD2, HDMI 1/
Channels Block
ANT 1
ANT 1
Highlight Allow All in step 6
above, and then highlight
Done, and press ENTER.
New PIN Code
1
2
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
ANT 2
3
Cable Box
4
HDMI 2, PC and channels 3 and 4. Select Video+ if you
use the antenna terminal to play a video tape.
Note: Make sure the POP is not on channel 3 or 4.
5
6
7
Allow All
Block All
Cancel
Done
8
9
Off: Unlocks all video input sources.
10
6. Press ENTER.
Note: Channel blocking may not take effect if you have a cable box
Note: When a CableCARD™ is inserted, Video+ will behave the same as
connected and use the cable box controls to change channels.
Video lock.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
99
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 9: Using the Locks menu
Using the GameTimer™
Using the control panel lock feature
You can use the GameTimer to set a time limit for playing a
video game (30–120 minutes). When the GameTimer is
activated, the TV enters VIDEO LOCK mode and locks out
the input source for the video game device.
You can lock the control panel buttons to prevent your settings
from being changed accidentally (by children, for example).
When the control panel lock is On, none of the controls on the
TV control panel will operate except POWER.
To set the GameTimer™:
To lock the front panel:
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.
2. Press z to display the PIN code entering screen.
3. Enter your four-digit PIN code and press ENTER.
4. Press z to highlight Game Timer and press •.
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.
2. Press z to display the PIN code entering screen.
3. Enter your four-digit PIN code and press ENTER.
4. Press z to highlight Front Panel Lock.
5. Press y or z to select the length of time until the Video
Lock is activated (30, 60, 90, or 120 minutes) and press
ENTER.
5. Press • to highlight On and press ENTER. When the
control panel is locked and a button on the control panel
except POWER button is pressed, the message “Not
Available” appears.
Locks
Enable Rating Blocking
Edit Rating Limits
Channels Block
Input Lock
Off
Off
Locks
30 min
60 min
90 min
120 min
Enable Rating Blocking
Edit Rating Limits
Channels Block
Input Lock
Off
Off
On
Off
Off
Off
Front Panel Lock
Game Timer
Off
Off
Off
Front Panel Lock
Game Timer
New PIN Code
New PIN Code
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
To cancel the GameTimer™:
Select Off in step 5 above.
To unlock the front panel:
Highlight Off in step 5 above, or press and hold the
VOLUME – button on the TV control panel for about 10
seconds until the volume icon appears on-screen.
To deactivate the video lock once the GameTimer has
activated it:
Set the VIDEO LOCK to Off (see “Locking video inputs” on
page 95).
TV control panel
Note:
• A message will appear on-screen when 10 minutes, 3
minutes, and 1 minute remain on the GameTimer.
• If the TV loses power with time remaining on the GameTimer,
when power is restored the TV will enter VIDEO LOCK mode
(as if the GameTimer had expired) and you will have to
deactivate the video lock (as described above).
VOLUME –
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
100
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the memory card JPEG picture viewer/MP3
audio player
10
You can use the memory card slots on the TV side panel to view
●
Maximum memory card capacity: 512 MB.
compatible JPEG files or play compatible MP3 files stored on a
memory card (see “Memory card specifications” below and at
right). You can display JPEG files in thumbnail mode or view
them as a slide show.
●
Maximum displayable JPEG image size: 8 MB.
• JPEG files larger than 8 MB will not display.
●
Maximum MP3 file size:
• MP3 files have no size limit other than the maximum capacity
of the memory card.
Note:
• Never remove the memory card or turn off the TV while
using the memory card. Doing so may result in loss of data and/
or damage to the memory card and/or TV. SUCH DAMAGE IS NOT
COVERED BY YOUR TOSHIBA WARRANTY.
• It is recommended that you back up your memory card data. Toshiba
is not liable for any damage caused by the use of any memory card
with this TV. Toshiba will not compensate for any lost data or
recording(s) caused by the use of such cards.
• For instructions on using your digital camera, refer to the owner’s
manual for your camera.
• For instructions on using your memory card, refer to the owner’s
manual for your memory card.
• Failure to take proper care of a memory card may prevent display of
pictures or playback of MP3 files from the card or result in damage to
the memory card and/or TV. SUCH DAMAGE IS NOT COVERED BY
YOUR TOSHIBA WARRANTY. See “Memory card care and
handling” on page 90.
●
●
Maximum displayable JPEG image resolution: 6000x4000
pixels.
Maximum number of files per directory: 370.
• All files over the 370th in a single directory will not display/play.
• Files in directories more than 10 levels down from the top level
directory will not display/play.
●
●
Maximum number of files per memory card: JPEG = 1,000;
MP3 = 200.
• All JPEG files over the 1,000th on a single memory card will not
display.
• All MP3 files over the 200th on a single memory card will not play.
File name restrictions:
• File names cannot contain the following characters: \ / : ? “ < > | .
• File names must contain US-ASCII characters only.
• The maximum file name length is 255 characters.
• The technical criteria set out in this owner’s manual are meant as a
guide only.
• Please be advised that you must obtain permission from the
applicable copyright owners to download copyrighted content,
including music files, in any format, including the MP3 format, prior to
the downloading thereof. Toshiba has no right to grant and does not
grant permission to download any copyrighted content.
• The memory card reader recognizes only “.mp3” and “.jpg”
file extensions.
• The MP3 player supports only ISO-8859-1 (US-ASCII/Western
European) character sets for MP3 meta-data (e.g, artist name,
album name, song title, etc.)
Memory card specifications
●
●
JPEG picture viewer:
• The picture viewer supports JPEG format images only.
●
Supported memory card types:
• The files on your memory card must be in a file and directory
format compatible with the TV or they will not display on the TV.
–
Memory Card (ver. 1.0)
– MMC (MultiMediaCard™)
• Images processed and/or edited on a personal computer (PC)
may not display properly or at all. Some digital cameras may store
images in a format that is not compatible with the TV.
– Memory Stick™ (Pro)
– xD-Picture Card™ (16MB-512MB)
– CompactFlash® memory card (Type1)
MP3 audio player:
• The audio player supports MP3 format files only.
Note: The picture viewer and audio player support FAT16 formatted
cards only. Other memory card formats (including, but not limited to,
FAT32 and NTFS) are not supported.
• The files on your memory card must be in a file and directory
format compatible with the TV or they will not play.
• Files processed and/or edited on a personal computer (PC) may
not play properly or at all. Some MP3 files may be in a format that
is not compatible with the TV.
______________
•
•
is a trademark.
MMC and MultiMediaCard are trademarks of Infineon Technologies AG
and licensed to MMCA (MultiMediaCard Association).
• MP3 files must have the following format:
- MPEG1 (ISO/IEC 11172-3) Layer3.
•
•
•
Memory Stick is a trademark of Sony Corporation.
xD-Picture Card is a trademark.
Toshiba is an authorized licensee of the CompactFlash® and CF logo®
- Sampling frequency—MPEG1: 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz.
- Bitrate—MPEG1: 32–320 kbps.
registered trademarks.
- Channels—Stereo, Joint stereo, Dual channel, Single channel.
- ID3 Ver. 1, Ver. 2.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
101
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 10: Using the memory card JPEG picture viewer/MP3 audio player
Using the memory card JPEG picture viewer/MP3 audio player (continued)
2. In a few seconds, the images automatically display on-
Using the JPEG picture viewer
screen, with one as a large picture and six in thumbnail
format.
Note: If you stored both JPEG and MP3 files on the same
memory card, the JPEG picture viewer will start automatically
when you insert the memory card in the TV. To start the audio
player, you must first press EXIT to close the picture viewer and
then start the audio player while the memory card is still
inserted. See “To start the MP3 audio player when a memory
card is already inserted,” on page 90. You cannot use the
picture viewer and audio player at the same time.
Picture Viewer
1
of
6
May 28 04
2
of
6
Jan
8
04
3
of
6
Jan 18 04
4
of
6
May 12 04
5
of
6
Sep 18 03
6
of
6
Oct 10 10
Rotate
Next
Slide Show
EXIT Exit
To view digital photos on your TV:
3. Press x to rotate the large picture 90° counterclockwise.
1. Insert a memory card into the appropriate memory card
slot on the side of your TV.
Picture Viewer
1
of
6
May 28 04
2
of
6
Note:
Jan
8
04
3
of
6
Jan 18 04
• Never insert more than one memory card at a time.
4
of
6
May 12 04
• Be sure to insert the card correctly—label side facing left and
the end with the notched corner (if applicable) inserted into the
memory card slot.
5
of
6
Sep 18 03
6
of
6
Oct 10 10
Rotate
Next
Slide Show
EXIT Exit
• When a CompactFlash memory card is inserted correctly, the
ejector button pops out (see illustration below).
4. Press • to rotate the large picture 90° clockwise.
Picture Viewer
1
of
6
May 28 04
2
of
6
Memory card slots
Jan
8
04
3
of
6
Jan 18 04
4
of
6
May 12 04
5
of
6
Sep 18 03
6
of
6
Oct 10 10
Rotate
Next
Slide Show
EXIT Exit
●
TV side panel
5. Press y or z to select another picture as the large picture.
6. Press ENTER to view your pictures in a slide show.
Picture Viewer
CompactFlash
ejector button
During the slide show:
or
• To stop on an image during the slide show, press ENTER.
To resume the slide show, press ENTER again.
or
• To rotate the picture, press x or •, and then press ENTER.
CompactFlash
memory card
• To select another image, press y or z, and then press
ENTER.
xD-Picture Card
MMC
(MultiMediaCard)
• To stop the slide show and return to the picture viewer,
press CH RTN.
• To stop the slide show and return to the regular TV screen,
press EXIT.
or
™
Secure Digital
SD
Memory Stick
(Secure Digital)
memory card
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
102
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 10: Using the memory card JPEG picture viewer/MP3 audio player
Using the memory card JPEG picture viewer/MP3 audio player (continued)
To set the slide show interval:
Using the MP3 audio player
Note: The picture viewer must be closed before you can set the
slide show interval.
Note:
• If you stored both JPEG and MP3 files on the same memory card, the
JPEG picture viewer will start automatically when you insert the
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight Slide Show Interval and press ENTER. Select the
interval from the menu sidebar (2, 5, 10, 15, or 20
seconds).
memory card in the TV. To start the audio player, you must first press
EXIT to close the picture viewer and then start the audio player while
the memory card is still inserted. See “To start the MP3 audio player
when a memory card is already inserted,” next page. You cannot
use the picture viewer and audio player at the same time.
Setup
• Make all desired adjustments to the surround, bass, treble, and
balance before starting the MP3 audio player.
• Permission is required in order to download MP3 files and music from
the Internet. Toshiba has no right to grant such permission. Permission
should always be sought from the copyright owner.
Installation
2 sec
5 sec
Sleep Timer
On/Off Timer
PC Settings
10 sec
15 sec
20 sec
HDMI 1 Audio
HDMI 2 Audio
Slide Show Interval
Auto
Auto
2 Sec
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
To start the MP3 audio player when a memory card is not
already inserted:
To close the picture viewer:
1. Insert a memory card into the appropriate memory card
slot on the side of your TV (see page 88 for details).
Press EXIT to close the picture viewer and return to the regular
TV screen.
Note:
• Never insert more than one memory card at a time.
To restart the picture viewer while the memory card is still
inserted:
• Be sure to insert the card correctly—label side facing left and
the end with the notched corner (if applicable) inserted into the
memory card slot.
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.
2. Highlight Picture Viewer and press ENTER.
• When a CompactFlash memory card is inserted correctly, the
ejector button pops out (see page 88).
2. If you have only MP3 files on the memory card, the audio
player will launch within a few seconds after being inserted
and begin playing the first MP3 file on the memory card.
Applications
TV Guide On Screen
Audio Player
Picture Viewer
Digital CC/Audio Selector
CableCARD
Audio Player
Title
Artist
Ser No.1 in D, Op.11...
SCO/Sir Charles...
Vol
Requiem, Op. 5: IV. R... Robert Shaw/Atla...
Rapsodie Espagnole:... Jesus Lopez-Cobo...
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Moolight Sonata, movement
A-M Classical
III. Sanctus: Sanctu...
Boston Baroque/M...
Piano Sonata, K. 545... A-M Classical
Pathétique Sonata, m... A-M Classical
3. Follow the steps under “To view digital photos on your
TV” on the previous page.
Chopin Prelude No. ...
Piano Sonata, K. 545...
Andrys
A-M Classical
A-M Classical
Moolight Sonata, mo...
To close the picture viewer and remove the memory card:
1. Press EXIT to close the picture viewer and return to the
regular TV screen.
Navigate
EXIT Exit
Select
3. Press yz x • to navigate to the rewind, pause, fast
forward, skip backward, skip forward, volume, and mute
buttons, or to select another MP3, and then press ENTER.
NOTE: ALWAYS CLOSE THE PICTURE
VIEWER BEFORE REMOVING THE
MEMORY CARD.
If you remove the memory card while viewing pictures, the card
and/or saved data may be damaged. THIS TYPE OF DAMAGE
IS NOT COVERED UNDER YOUR TOSHIBA WARRANTY.
To use the mute function
Press yz x • to select the
(mute) button, and then press
ENTER. See page 89 for details on muting the sound.
2. For a CompactFlash memory card, press the ejector button
and then pull the card straight out from the TV. For all
other memory cards, pull the card straight out from the TV.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
103
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 10: Using the memory card JPEG picture viewer/MP3 audio player
Using the memory card JPEG picture viewer/MP3 audio player (continued)
Using the MP3 audio player (continued)
To start the MP3 audio player when a memory card is
already inserted:
Memory card care and handling
NOTE: ALWAYS CLOSE THE AUDIO
PLAYER BEFORE REMOVING THE
MEMORY CARD.
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.
2. Highlight Audio Player
If you remove the memory card while playing MP3 files, the card
and/or saved data may be damaged. THIS TYPE OF DAMAGE
IS NOT COVERED UNDER YOUR TOSHIBA WARRANTY.
and press ENTER.
Applications
TV Guide On Screen
3. Press yz x • to
Audio Player
Picture Viewer
navigate to the rewind,
pause, fast forward, skip
Digital CC/Audio Selector
CableCARD
• Use index labels made exclusively for your specific brand of
memory card. Do not use commercially sold labels, which
can cause a malfunction when the card is inserted or
ejected.
backward, skip forward,
volume, and mute
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
buttons, and then press
ENTER.
• If the image does not appear correctly or the audio file does
not play correctly, clean the metallic area of the memory
card using a soft, dry, lint-free, anti-static cloth and then
reinsert the card.
Note: After 30 seconds a screen saver will appear. To access the
screen saver immediately, press any button on the remote control.
To close the MP3 audio player:
• Prevent the metallic area on the memory card from coming
in contact with dust, dirt, or other foreign particles. Do not
touch the metallic area of the memory card with your hands
or otherwise handle it with anything other than a soft, dry,
lint-free, anti-static cloth.
Press EXIT to close the audio player and return to the regular
TV screen.
To close the MP3 audio player and remove the memory card:
1. Press EXIT to close the audio player and return to the
regular TV screen.
Note: Toshiba is not liable for any damage caused by the use
of any memory card with this TV. Toshiba will not compensate
for any lost data or recordings caused by the use of such
cards.
2. For a CompactFlash memory card, press the ejector button
and then pull the card straight out from the TV. For all
other memory cards, pull the card straight out from the TV.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
104
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting your TV to the Network
You can network the TV with your home Internet service to remotely schedule recordings and reminders by sending an email to the TV.
11
To use this feature, you must have Internet e-mail service in your home and two separate e-mail addresses (your personal e-mail and a
second email address for use solely by the TV). Contact your ISP (Internet Service Provider) for these services.
Use yzx • or the number buttons to enter your network
address (IP address, Subnet Mask, Gateway (Router), and DNS)
provided by the internet service provider.
Setting up the Network connection
When finished, highlight Done and press ENTER.
Setting up the Network address
The following explains how to manually input settings such as
the IP address, etc.
Basic Network Setup
Please enter your Network Address Information
xxx xxx xxx xxx
xxx xxx xxx xxx
xxx xxx xxx xxx
xxx xxx xxx xxx
IP Address
Subnet Mask
Gateway(Router)
DNS(Domain Name Saver)
Note:
Cancel
Done
• You must first set up THINC™ to connect to a home network,
see page 30.
Network address set up is finished, and the Network menu
returns.
• This feature is only for remotely scheduling recordings and
reminders. You will not be able to access the Internet through
the TV.
To obtain the Network address automatically
1. Follow steps 1-2 above.
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. The Network
menu will appear.
2. Highlight Basic Network Setup, and press ENTER.
Basic Network Setup
Obtain network address automatically?
Network
Basic Network Setup
Recording Email Setup
Home File Server Setup
Yes
No
3. Highlight Yes, and then press ENTER.
Basic Network Setup
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Please waite...
3. Highlight Basic Network Setup, and press ENTER. The
screen to confirm automatically obtaining the Network
address appears. Highlight No, and then press ENTER.
The Completion screen will appear after the address is assigned
from the DHCP server. Press ENTER to return to the Network
menu.
Basic Network Setup
Obtain network address automatically?
If obtaining the address from the DHCP server fails, the Error
screen will appear. Make sure the the cable is connected to the
RJ-45 port terminal securely, and highlight Yes, press ENTER,
and set it up again.
Yes
No
Note: If the network address is automatically obtained, see
“To obtain the Network address automatically” at right.
Error.Unable to obtain network address information.Please
re-check network connections and DHCP server status.
Try Again?
4. Basic Network Setup menu appears.
Basic Network Setup
Yes
No
Please enter your Network Address Information
IP Address
Subnet Mask
Gateway(Router)
DNS(Domain Name Saver)
Cancel
Done
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
105
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 11: Connecting your TV to the Network
• ID:
Setting up the Network connection (continued)
An ID number is required to add or cancel the timer
recording. Press ENTER, and then the keyboard will
appear on the screen.
Press yzx • to select a character for the first space and
then press ENTER. Repeat to enter the rest of the
characters.
To reset the Network address
1. Follow steps 1-2 of “Setting up the Network address”.
2. Highlight Basic Network Setup, and press ENTER. The
screen to confirm resetting appears. Highlight Yes and press
ENTER.
Note:
Enter a mail verification ID containing 6 or more characters.
After you have entered your ID number, then highlight Enter
and press ENTER.
Basic Network Setup
Your Basic Network Setup is complete. Would you like to start over?
Yes
No
Required ID
Please enter a mail verification ID containing 6 or more characters
_
Next, follow step 4 on “Setting up the Network address”.
1
q
2
3
e
4
r
5
t
6
y
7
u
8
i
9
o
0
p
-
[
=
]
w
a
s
d
f
g
h
j
k
l
;
'
z
x
c
v
b
n
m
,
.
/
Shift
Enter
BS
Cancel
Clear
Set up the Email account
• Email address:
Press ENTER to display the keyboard on the screen, and
then enter your Email address for your TV.
To set up the Email account for timer recording by Email, set
the Recording Email setup screen as follows.
• Account:
Note:
Press ENTER to display the keyboard on the screen, and
then enter your Email account for your TV.
• If you set up the TV address with the same name as another
address, large Emails or Email with attached files will be deleted
automatically. You must have an Email address for sole use by the
TV.
• Password:
Press ENTER to display the keyboard on the screen, and
then enter your Email password for your TV.
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
• Incoming Mail Server (POP3):
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. The Network
menu appears.
Press ENTER to display the keyboard on the screen, and
then enter your Incoming mail server name of your TV
Email.
• Outgoing Mail Server (SMTP):
Network
Basic Network Setup
Recording Email Setup
Home File Server Setup
Press ENTER to display the keyboard on the screen, and
then enter your Outgoing mail server name of your TV
Email.
• Email Authorization:
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
Select On or Off. When you select ON, the TV accepts
timer recordings only from an address selected in
“Authorized Email” below. When you select Off, the TV
accepts timer recordings from multiple addresses.
3. Highlight Recording Email Setup, and press ENTER. The
Recording Email Setup menu appears.
Recording Email Setup
Please enter your Email Setup Information.
• Authorized E-mail:
TV-Guide E-mail
ID Required
On
On
Press ENTER to display the keyboard on the screen, and
then enter your desired address. the TV accepts timer
recordings only from the desired address. You can not input
this field when you set the Email Authorization to Off.
XXXXXXXXXXXX
ID
Email Address
Account
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXX
Password
*****
Incoming Mail Server
Outgoing Mail Server
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
When finished, test the setting to make sure the account is set
up accurately.
Email Authorization
Authorized Email
On
Enter YOUR email here
Test
cancel
Done
Highlight Test and press ENTER
4. Set up the contents below using yzx • and ENTER;
• TV-Guide Email:
Select On or Off. When you select On, it is available to timer
record by Email through the TV-Guide Email function.
If the account is set up accurately, highlight “Done” and press
ENTER.
• ID required:
Select On or Off.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
106
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 11: Connecting your TV to the Network
must be specified. Sample ADD command email contents
(adding a Reminder):
Set up the Email account (continued)
●
Delete:
Note:
The DELETE command removes an already scheduled
reminder or recording. The INPUT, CHANNEL, DATE,
TIME, DURATION, and TYPE must be specified. Sample
DELETE command email contents (deleting a Recording):
• If you set the Email Authorization to Off, the TV will accept timer
recordings from each address. For multiple users, set to Off so that
each user can use the timer recording function by Email. Note that if
your TV address becomes known to outside parties, you may receive
junk Email, so please be careful with your mail address.
• It is better to set up your ID using a different address from the POP
address. If the ID address is the same as the POP address, your POP
address may become known to outside parties.
Subject: delete
————
Id myID1234 Delete ANTENNA-1 102-1 6/10/2005
19:00 1:00 RECORD
Timer recording via Email
●
Get:
The GET command retrieves a list of currently scheduled
You can timer record or delete the programs you set by sending
an Email to the TV. With the Email Recording feature, the
following commands are available: Add, Delete, Get, or Help.
When you send an Email to the TV, make sure to follow the
form below.
reminders or recordings. Sample GET command email contents:
Subject: get
————
get
Note:
• Text or Rich Text (HTML style) is accepted.
• Emails over 16K are automatically deleted.
• Emails with attached files are automatically deleted.
●
Help:
The HELP command retrieves information on the syntax and
purpose of commands and fields. Sample HELP command
email contents:
Subject: help
————
help
After receiving and processing the email, the TV will reply to the
email. The reply email contains one of the following messages:
●
Add:
• ADD SUCCESS
• DELETE SUCCESS
• GET SUCCESS
• HELP SUCCESS
The ADD command schedules a new recording or reminder.
The INPUT, CHANNEL, DATE, TIME, and DURATION
Subject: add
————
id myID1234
command add
input ant-1
chan 102-1
date 06/10/2005
time 7 pm
duration 1hr
record
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
107
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 11: Connecting your TV to the Network
Using the audio player/picture viewer via network
You can enjoy the MP3 files or JPEG files which are stored on a PC, using only the TV remote via network. First, set up the folders
which for storing MP3 files or JPEG files to share with the PC, then set up the Home File Server on the TV.
●
Picture viewer
4. To allow anonymous logins (logins without passwords),
select the “Security” tab.
• Picture viewer supports JPG or JPEG format images (96-128
kbps) only.
• Maximum number of files: 1,000 files
• Maximum file size: 8,192,000 Bytes per file
• Maximum directory folder depth is 10
• Compatible with Windows NetBios
●
Audio Player
• Audio Player supports MP3 format files (96-128 kbps) only.
• Maximum numbers of files: 200 files
• Maximum file size: 51,200,000 Bytes per file
• Maximum directory folder depth is 10
5. Click on “Add…”
• Compatible with Windows NetBios
Procedure for setting up mp3 sharing
on Windows XP machine running
service pack 2
1. On the PC hosting the folders and files to be shared, right
click the folder.
6. In the “Enter the object names to select” box, type the user
name and click on “Check Names”.
7. Ensure that the user name shows up as a recognized type.
Click “OK”.
2. From the pop-up menu select “Sharing and Security…”
8. Click on OK all the way through.
3. In the folder properties dialog, select “Share this folder”.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
108
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 11: Connecting your TV to the Network
Using the audio player/picture viewer via network (continued)
Procedure for Windows XP with
service pack 1
How do I check if my machine is
running service pack 1 or 2?
1. On the PC hosting the folders and files to be shared, right
click the folder.
1. Click “Start” button
2. Click “Settings | Control Panel”.
3. In the Control Panel, double-click on “System”.
2. From the pop-up menu select “Sharing and Security…”
4. Select the “General” tab to check what operating system
and service pack is currently being used.
3. In the folder properties dialog box, select “Share this folder
on the network”.
4. Click “OK”.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
109
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 11: Connecting your TV to the Network
Using the audio player/picture viewer via network (continued)
Set up the Home File server
To start the Picture viewer/Audio
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.
player
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. The Network
menu will appear.
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.
2. Highlight Picture Viewer or Audio Player, and press
ENTER.
Network
Basic Network Setup
Recording Email Setup
Home File Server Setup
Applications
TV Guide On Screen
Audio Player
Picture Viewer
Digital CC/Audio Selector
CableCARD
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
3. Highlight Home File server setup, and press ENTER.
The Home File Server Setup menu will appear.
Navigate
CH RTN
Back
EXIT Exit
Select
3. The picture viewer or audio player will launch.
Home File Server Setup
Please enter your Home File Server Setup information.
Please Wait...
Home Server Name
User Name
––
––
Picture Viewer
//ABCD/JPEG
Password
1 of 6
*****
May 28 04
JPEG Picture Directory
MP3 Music Directory
––
2 of 6
––
Jan 8 04
3 of 6
Cancel
Done
Jan 18 04
4 of 6
May 12 04
5 of 6
4. Press x or • to select the desired Home Server Name.
Sep 18 03
6 of 6
Oct 10 10
Home File Server Setup
Please Wait...
Rotate
Slide Show
EXIT Exit
Next
Please enter your Home File Server Setup information.
Home Server Name
User Name
ABCD
––
4. Follow the steps under “To view digital photos on your
TV” on page 102, or “Using the MP3 audio player” on
page 103.
Password
*****
JPEG Picture Directory
MP3 Music Directory
––
––
Cancel
Done
5. Select the User Name or Password field using y or z, and
then press ENTER to display the keyboard on the screen.
Enter the User Name or Password on this screen.
Note: To enter the Home Server Name or Password, see “Set up the
Email account” (on page 106).
6. When you highlight the JPEG Picture Directory, the shared
folder name will be displayed on the screen. Press x or • to
select your desired folder.
Home File Server Setup
Please Wait...
Please enter your Home File Server Setup information.
Home Server Name
User Name
ABCD
XYZ
Password
*****
JPEG
MP3
JPEG Picture Directory
MP3 Music Directory
Cancel
Done
7. When you highlight the MP3 Music Directory, the shared
folder will be displayed on the screen. Press x or • to select
your desired folder.
8. Highlight “Done” and press ENTER.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
110
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
111
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Troubleshooting
12
Before calling a service technician, please check the following table for a possible cause of the symptom and some solutions.
Symptom
Solution
TV will not turn on
• Make sure the power cord is plugged in, and then press POWER.
• The remote control batteries may be dead. Replace the batteries or try the control panel buttons.
• If you have recently replaced the lamp unit, make sure the lamp unit and lamp unit door are installed
properly (pages 103–105).
• The lamp unit may need to be replaced (pages 103–105). Also see “LED indications” on page 99.
Picture problems
• Check the antenna/cable connections (Chapter 2).
• Press INPUT on the remote control or TV/VIDEO on the TV control panel and select a valid video input
source (page 67). If no device is connected to any of the inputs on the TV, no picture will display when
you select that particular input source. For device connection details, see Chapter 2.
• Antenna reception may be poor. Use a highly directional outdoor antenna (if applicable).
• The station may have broadcast difficulties. Try another channel.
• Adjust the picture qualities (page 79).
• If you are using a VCR, make sure the TV/VCR button on the remote control is set correctly (page 26).
• If you have two VCRs connected to your TV, do not connect the same VCR to the TV’s output and input
connections at the same time (page 18).
• Do not connect a standard video cable and an S-video cable to VIDEO-1 or VIDEO-2 on the TV back (or
VIDEO-3 on the TV side) at the same time (Chapter 2).
Noisy picture
• If you are watching a tuned analog channel (off-air broadcast or Cable TV), set the CableClear®/DNR
feature to AUTO to reduce visible interference in the TV picture (page 80).
Video Input Selection
problems
• If the Input Selection window does not appear when you press INPUT on the remote control or
TV/VIDEO on the TV control panel, press INPUT or TV/VIDEO a second time, which will change to the
next video input source and display the Input Selection window.
Cannot view external signals
or channel 3 or 4
• If you cannot view signals from external devices connected to VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2,
VIDEO 3, or ColorStream,® or from channels 3 or 4, make sure the Input Lock is set to Off (page 95).
Black box on screen
Poor color or no color
• Set the Closed Caption feature to Off (page 82).
• The station may have broadcast difficulties. Try another channel.
• Adjust the Tint and/or Color (page 79).
• When the ColorStream® signal source is active, the VIDEO OUT terminal outputs blank video. To receive
video from the VIDEO OUT signal, a standard video or S-video IN terminal must be used instead of the
ColorStream® connections.
POP problems
• The VIDEO OUT terminal will not output the POP picture (pages 18 and 76).
• If you label all of the inputs as “Hide,” the POP feature will be disabled. If you then attempt to access the
POP feature, the message “Not available” will appear on-screen (page XX).
Picture brightness changes soon • If you set the lamp mode to Low Power, each time you turn on the TV, the lamp will start out in High
after turning on TV
Bright mode but will switch to Low Power mode in approximately 1 minute. You will notice a change in
screen brightness when this happens. This is normal and is not a sign of malfunction. (See page XX.)
Picture and sound are out of sync • As with all products that contain a digital display, in rare instances, when viewing certain content (e.g..
television broadcasts, video games, DVD), you may notice that the sound and picture are slightly out of
sync. This phenomenon can be caused by various factors including, without limitation, video processing
within the TV, video processing in an attached gaming system, and video processing/different
compression rates used by broadcasters in their programming. You may want to try one or more of the
following suggestions, which may help to reduce the effect of this phenomenon:
- If the TV is connected to an A/V receiver that has a programmable audio delay feature, use this feature
to help synchronize the sound to the picture.
- If you notice this phenomenon only on certain TV channels, please contact your local broadcast,
cable, or satellite provider to inform them of this issue.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
112
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting
Symptom
Solution
Memory card
problems
• Make sure you are using a supported or valid memory card format (page 87).
• Make sure you have saved the picture files in the correct file format (page 87).
• The card may be inserted improperly. Remove the card and reinsert it (page 88).
• The memory card may be empty.
• The memory card may be damaged.
“Now Booting” message
appears on-screen
•
If you unplug the power cord while the TV is on, when you plug the power cord in again, the message
“Now Booting…” will display on-screen until the picture appears. This is normal and is not a sign of
malfunction.
Sound problems
• Check the antenna/cable connections (see Chapter 2).
• The station may have broadcast difficulties. Try another channel.
• The sound may be muted. Press VOLUME.
• If you hear no sound, try setting the MTS feature to STEREO mode (page 84).
• Make sure the Speakers function in the Audio Setup menu is set correctly (page 86).
• If you are not receiving a second audio program from a known SAP source, make sure the MTS feature is
set to SAP mode (page 84).
• If you hear audio that seems “incorrect” for the program you are watching (such as music or a foreign
language), the SAP mode may be on. Set the MTS feature to STEREO mode (page 84).
• When using an external audio amplifier, if you connect the amplifier to the VAR. AUDIO OUT terminals,
the volume of the TV and amplifier must be set above 0 or you will not hear any sound (page 20).
Remote control problems
• Make sure the remote control is set to the correct device mode (page 28).
• Remove all obstructions between the remote control and the TV.
• The remote control batteries may be dead. Replace the batteries (page 28).
• Your TV remote control may not operate certain features on your external device. Refer to the owner’s
manual for your other device to determine its available features. If your TV remote control does not
operate a specific feature on another device, use the remote control that came with the device (page 28).
• If the TV still does not act as expected, use the Restore Factory Defaults procedure as described on page
52.
Channel tuning problems
• Make sure the remote control is set to the correct device mode (page 28).
• The channel may have been erased from the channel memory by the Channel Add/Delete feature. Add
the channel to the channel memory (page 43).
• The channel may be blocked by the Channels Block feature. Unblock the channel (page 95).
• If you are unable to tune digital channels, check the antenna configuration (page 41). If you are still
unable to tune digital channels, clear all channels from the channel list (page 43) and reprogram
channels into the channel memory (page 42). If you are still unable to tune digital channels, use the
Restore Factory Defaults procedure as described on page 52. Also see “Other problems,” on the next
page.
Closed caption problems
• If the program or video you selected is not closed-captioned, no captions will display on-screen
(page 82).
• If text is not available, a black rectangle may appear on-screen. If this happens, turn off the closed
caption feature (page 82).
• A closed caption signal may not display correctly in the following situations: a) when a videotape has
been dubbed; b) when the signal reception is weak; or c) when the signal reception is nonstandard
(page 82).
Rating Blocking (V-Chip) problems
• If you forget your PIN code: While the PIN code entering screen is displayed, press RECALL four times
within 5 seconds. The PIN code you previously stored will be cleared (page 93).
• The V-Chip feature is available for the U.S. V-Chip system only (page 94).
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
113
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting
Symptom
Solution
Recording problems
• If you use the TV’s remote control to start recording, you will not be able to change inputs (page 67),
open the POP window (page 76), or open the FAV SCAN multi-window (page 78). If you attempt to do
so, the message “Not Available While Recording” will appear on-screen.
• If you are recording a digital channel, you will only be able to change analog channels while the recording
is in progress. If you are recording an analog channel, you will only be able to change digital channels
while the recording is in progress. This is because the TV tuner that is being recorded (digital or analog)
will be locked on the channel that is currently recording.
• It is recommended that you use the TV’s remote control to start recording. If you use a device other than
the TV’s remote control to start recording and then attempt to access a feature that is normally denied
during recording (POP mode, FAV SCAN mode, changing inputs,) the recorded audio and/or video may
not be what you intended to record. See pages 67 and 71.
• If you connected a Symbio™ AVHD recorder, in order to use its full functionality, you must first set up the
TV Guide On Screen™ system (page 23 and Chapter 5).
Other problems
• If your TV’s problem has not been addressed in this Troubleshooting section or the recommended
solution has not worked, use the Restore Factory Defaults procedure as described on page 52.
TV stops responding to controls
• If the TV stops responding to the controls on the remote control or TV side panel buttons and you cannot
turn off the TV, press and hold the POWER button on the TV front panel for 5 or more seconds to reset
the TV.
Cannot connect to network.
• Check modem and splitter connections.
• Make sure the splitter is connected to the modem or TEL.
• Confirm modem’s operation with this manual.
• Make sure your network address or E-mail account are set correctly (page xx).
Disable network connection
Unstable network connection.
• Check the LAN cable connection.
• Check that the modem’s power cord is plugged in.
• Make sure your network address or E-mail account are set correctly (page xx).
• Unplug the LAN cable from an outlet, and then connect again.
Cannot set recording timer by E-mail. • Select “Test” to confirm the setup( page xx).
• Select “Done” after setting up( page xx).
• See Chapter 11 in this manual.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
114
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting
LED indications
The yellow and blue LED lights on the TV (at the bottom center of the TV) indicate the TV’s status, as described below:
TV front
Blue LED
Yellow LED
LED Indication
Condition
Solution
1) Yellow blinks continuously The lamp unit door is not seated
Turn OFF the TV and unplug the power cord. Review “How to
replace the lamp unit” on pages 104–105 to ensure that the lamp
door is installed securely. If the problem persists, contact a Toshiba
Authorized Service Center.
at 3-second intervals.
properly.
Blue blinks continuously
at 0.5-second intervals.
2) Yellow blinks continuously The lamp is not working properly. The TV will automatically try to restart itself eight times (see item
at 0.5-second intervals;
#3).
Blue is ON (solid).
3) Yellow and Blue blink
continuously at
The lamp is not working properly Turn the TV OFF and then ON again. If the problem persists,
after the eighth automatic restart
(see item #2).
replace the lamp unit (see pages 103–105). If the problem still
exists, contact a Toshiba Authorized Service Center.
1-second intervals.
4) Yellow is OFF;
An abnormal temperature
Blue blinks at 0.2-second increase has occurred.
Turn OFF the TV. Check to make sure all slots and openings in the
TV cabinet are not covered, blocked, or dusty. Turn ON the TV
again. If the problem persists, contact a Toshiba Authorized Service
Center.
intervals 4 times (repeat).
5) Yellow is OFF;
Blue blinks continuously
at 0.5-second intervals.
Abnormal operation
(including cooling fan stop).
Turn OFF the TV and unplug the power cord. Plug the power cord
in again and turn ON the TV. If the problem persists, contact a
Toshiba Authorized Service Center.
6) Yellow is OFF;
Blue blinks continuously
at 1-second intervals.
Abnormal operation of BUS line.
The color wheel has stopped.
Turn OFF the TV and unplug the power cord. Plug the power cord
in again and turn ON the TV. If the problem persists, contact a
Toshiba Authorized Service Center.
7) Yellow is OFF;
Blue blinks at 0.2-second
intervals 3 times (repeat).
Turn OFF the TV and unplug the power cord. Plug the power cord
in again and turn ON the TV. If the problem persists, contact a
Toshiba Authorized Service Center.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
115
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting
TV Guide On Screen™ FAQs
The following are frequently asked questions about the TV Guide On Screen™ system. The answers represent the most likely solutions
to the problem.
7. Q: I had a power outage. Do I need to go through initial
After you set up the TV Guide On Screen™ system (Chapter 5), the
program guide opens automatically by default when you turn on
the TV. You can turn off the automatic program guide (see page 40)
and instead press the TV GUIDE button on the remote control to
manually open the TV Guide On Screen™ program guide.
setup of the TV Guide On Screen™ system again?
A: No. The information you entered is stored in the TV Guide
On Screen™ system memory.
Note: For Cable box users, the TV must be OFF and the Cable
box must be left ON for the TV Guide On Screen™ system to
receive channel line-up information.
SETUP
1. Q: What if I move and my ZIP code or postal code
8. Q: How do I connect the G-LINK™ (IR blaster) cable to
changes?
the G-LINK™ input on the TV?
A: Highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z to highlight
Change System Settings (page 65), and then press ENTER.
Follow the on-screen prompts to enter new information
(see Chapter 3 for details). It can take up to 24 hours to
receive new data.
A: See Chapter 2: Connecting your TV in this manual.
You also can refer to the TV Guide On Screen™ prompts
during VCR or Cable box setup.
9. Q: When will I be able to view my TV program listings and
2. Q: What if I change my cable hook-up to antenna or vice
use other TV Guide On Screen™ system features?
versa?
A: You will be able to use initial program listings within 24
hours of initial setup. It may take up to one week to receive
the full eight days of program listings.
A: Highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z to highlight
Change System Settings (page 65), and then press ENTER.
Follow the on-screen prompts to enter new input
information and rescan channels for the new input (see
Chapter 3 for details).
10. Q: What should I do if I cannot complete initial setup?
A: If you are unable to complete initial setup using the owner’s
manual and the on-screen prompts, please call Toshiba’s
National Service Division at 1-800-631-3811.
3. Q: What if I change cable boxes?
A: Highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z to highlight
Change System Settings (page 65), and then press ENTER.
Follow the on-screen prompts to enter new input
information and rescan channels for the new input (see
Chapter 3 for details).
11. Q: If I make a mistake during setup, how do I go back to
the previous step?
A: Complete the remaining setup steps. When “Confirming
Your Settings” appears, select “No, repeat setup process.”
Follow the on-screen prompts and input the correct
information.
4. Q: I used to have a cable box, but now I get direct cable.
What do I do?
A: Highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z to highlight
Change System Settings (page 65), and then press ENTER.
Follow the on-screen prompts to enter new input
information and rescan channels for the new input (see
Chapter 3 for details).
12. Q: What if the channel number is not visible on my cable
box?
A: Your cable box may be defaulting to a clock or time display
once the channel changes. Watch the box carefully when
testing the cable box brand code to see if the channel
changes to 09.
5. Q: If I add a recorder or change my cable service, how do I
change my Setup information?
13. Q: Why won’t my VCR turn on?
A: Highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z to highlight
Change System Settings (page 65), and then press ENTER.
Follow the on-screen prompts to enter new information
(see Chapter 3 for details). It can take up to 24 hours to
receive new data.
A: There are several possibilities:
a) An incorrect or “no VCR” code was entered during the
TV Guide On Screen™ initial setup. Press the GUIDE
button on the remote control, and then press • to
highlight SETUP. Press z to highlight “Change system
settings,” and then press ENTER. Follow the on-screen
prompts to select the correct VCR information.
6. Q: Why does it take up to 24 hours for the TV Guide
On Screen™ system to be ready for use?
b) Make sure the G-LINK™ (IR blaster) cable is connected
correctly (see page 25).
A: The initial setup process consists of finding the stations in
your area that carry the TV Guide On Screen™ system data
and tuning to those stations to receive the setup and
listings data.
c) The VCR record timer is on. Turn off the timer.
d) The wired remote VCR is incompatible.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
116
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting
TV Guide On Screen™ FAQs (continued)
20. Q: After some show titles, I have noticed from 1 to 4 stars
CHANNEL LINEUPS & LISTINGS
14. Q: Why aren’t all my channels initially displayed?
(****). What does that mean?
A: These stars are a broadcast-industry ratings system used to
inform you of a show’s quality. The more stars, the better
the rating.
A: After initial setup, approximately 120 channels are
automatically displayed. The user may use the “Change
channel display” feature to turn ON or OFF additional
channels.
21. Q: What do the colors for shows in the Listings and Search
Note: Even though you have the option of enabling many
more channels, the system may not have the memory capacity
to hold detailed program descriptions for all of them.
screens indicate?
A: Green = Sports; Dark Blue = Children’s; Purple = Movies;
Teal = Other Show.
15. Q: When I opened the TV Guide On Screen™ system, I was
asked to choose from more than one channel lineup.
What should I do?
22. Q: How do I add, delete, or change the assigned number of
channels on the TV Guide On Screen™ system?
A: Select the lineup that most closely matches the one for your
area. If after you choose the lineup, you want to make
changes to it, highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z to
select Change Channel Display. Follow the on-screen
instructions.
A: See the “Change channel display” section in the TV Guide
On Screen™ owner’s manual (see page 65).
23. Q: Why are some of my channels listed on the wrong
number?
A: There are several possibilities (see page 65 for details):
16. Q: Why do all my channels display “No Listing?”
A: The TV Guide On Screen™ system has not yet received its
data download. The phrase “No Listing” will be replaced
with program information during the next download cycle,
which will occur within the next 24-hour period.
a) Incorrect channel lineup was selected. Access “Change
system settings” and choose “Yes, but my channel lineup is
incorrect,” and then reselect the correct lineup.
b) Channel lineup changes have not yet been processed. Use
the “Change channel display” feature to make adjustments.
17. Q: Why do some of my channels display “No Listing?”
c) Initial setup was done incorrectly (that is, the wrong
ZIP/postal code was entered.) Redo the initial setup.
A: There are several possibilities:
a) The channels in question were recently turned ON (in
Change channel display) and TV Guide On Screen™ has
yet to receive its next data download.
b) After completing the initial setup, the first data download
of the day was interrupted by a VCR recording.
c) The TV power cord was left unplugged for an extended
period of time and the TV Guide On Screen™ system was
unable to receive program listings during the scheduled
download cycle.
d) Poor reception caused some of the data to be missed.
e) The cable box was turned OFF. The TV power cord must
be plugged in and the cable box must be ON.
g) A/V Cable: The VCR was turned OFF. If the connection
includes stereo cables with cable box to VCR and stereo
connection from VCR to television, the VCR must be ON.
24. Q: Why doesn’t the program highlighted match up with
the video window on my TV screen?
A: There are several possibilities (see page 65 for details):
a) The station in question made a late change to its scheduled
program listing and the TV Guide On Screen™ system has
not yet been updated.
b) The TV is receiving broadcasts through a modified or
boosted antenna system or a satellite dish (not supported
by the TV Guide On Screen™ system).
c) Initial setup was done incorrectly. (i.e., the wrong
ZIP/postal code was entered.) Redo the initial setup.
d) Incorrect channel lineup was selected. Access “Change
system settings” and choose “Yes, but my channel lineup
is incorrect,” and then reselect the correct lineup.)
18. Q: A show entry in the TV Guide On Screen™ system reads
e) The video window may be locked. Press SPLIT to unlock.
“No Listing.” What does that mean?
A: Show information for that entry was not available during
the last TV Guide On Screen™ system information update
(download). Show information is updated on a daily basis.
25. Q: Can I move my favorite stations to the top of the
TV Guide On Screen™ display screen?
A: Yes. Use the “Change channel display” feature to make
adjustments (see page 65). Highlight the station call letters
to be moved, then use the BLUE, GREEN, and/or
Number buttons to reassign the position of the station.
19. Q: I have seen the word “download” in reference to the
TV Guide On Screen™ system. What does that mean?
A: “Download” refers to the times throughout the day when
the TV Guide On Screen™ system is receiving channel and
listings information from your Cable or over-the-air
antenna transmission.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
117
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting
TV Guide On Screen™ FAQs (continued)
32. Q: Is Help available in the TV Guide On Screen™ system?
OPERATIONS
If so, how do I find it?
26. Q: How can I look for a specific show in the TV Guide
A: Yes. Highlight any of the five main Services (Listings,
Schedule, Recordings, Setup, Search) and press the INFO
key on the remote control. An expanded Info Box displays
additional help information. Press INFO again to close
the box.
On Screen™ system?
A: SEARCH lets you find shows by keyword, alphabetically,
or by category (HDTV, Movies, Sports, Children,
Educational, News, Variety, Series).
Help is also available in a panel menu. Press INFO to
display an expanded Info Box. Press INFO again to close
the box.
27. Q: My cable box will not change channels with the
TV Guide On Screen™ system. What’s wrong?
A: There are several possibilities:
RECORD/REMIND
33. Q: Can I tune to a different channel while recording a
a) The incorrect cable box code was entered during TV Guide
On Screen™ initial setup. Redo initial setup.
b) The G-LINK™ (IR blaster) cable may not be connected
properly (see page 25).
program?
A: No.
c) The cable box has no remote capability and is
incompatible.
34. Q: How many programs can be scheduled for RECORD in
the GUIDE?
A: There is no limit to the number of shows that can be
programmed into the schedule memory.
28. Q: How do I resize or close the Info window?
A: Press the INFO button on the remote control to resize the
Info window. Press the INFO button again to close the
Info window.
35. Q: If a program is scheduled to RECORD on a Regular
basis, does it count as five?
A: No, whether a program is scheduled ONCE,
REGULARLY, or WEEKLY, it only counts as one show in
the RECORD stack memory.
29. Q: Is there a way to go directly to the next day’s listings
without scrolling through each time slot?
A: Yes. In LISTINGS, highlight the station for which you
want to look ahead and use the Channel Number buttons
on the remote control to enter “24.” In the resulting menu,
press z two times to scroll down to select the HOURS
AHEAD option, and then press ENTER. You also can use
the SKIP button on the remote control.
36. Q: If I have a power failure, will I need to reset the
recorded shows I have already programmed?
A: The start times and channel numbers of shows that have
been programmed will be retained in the memory of the
TV Guide On Screen™ system. Titles will appear once
listings are restored.
30. Q: Why can’t I record a show? All I get is snow or a blue
screen.
37. Q: Can I set a Record or Remind event without
highlighting a show title in the TV Guide On Screen™
system?
A: There are several possibilities (without a cable box):
a) The recording unit was not connected or set up correctly.
A: Yes. TV Guide On Screen™ has a Manual Record and
Remind feature. Highlight SCHEDULE in the Service Bar,
and press MENU. Choose the event type, press ENTER,
and then enter the date, start and stop time, channel
number, and so forth.
b) The incorrect channel lineup was selected. Press GUIDE
and then • to highlight SETUP. Press z to highlight
“Change system settings,” and then press ENTER. Follow
the on-screen prompts to select the correct channel lineup.
31. Q: Why won’t my VCR change channels and why does it
38. Q: What do the frequencies for Record and Remind mean?
change to the wrong channel?
A: Once—records/reminds the show one time.
A: There are two possibilities (with a cable box):
Daily (manual only)—records the time, channel, input,
recorder combination Monday through Friday.
a) The VCR is not set on the correct output channel. Set the
VCR to 03, 04, or whichever output channel is set by your
cable system.
Regularly— records/reminds the show every time the show
airs on the same channel and starts at the same time.
b) The VCR and/or cable box are hooked up incorrectly.
Refer to your VCR owner’s manual or contact your Cable
TV company for proper wiring procedures.
Weekly— records/reminds the show each time the show
airs on the same day of the week, on the same channel and
starts at the same time.
Off (not cancel)—keeps the show in the Schedule list but
will not record/remind the show until the frequency is
changed.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
118
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix
13
Lamp unit replacement and care
When to replace the lamp unit
You should replace the lamp unit:
Replacing the lamp unit
(User-replaceable component)
• if the picture darkens and/or colors fade;
• if the screen (lamp) does not light (LED indication #3, page
99); or
• if you hear a loud noise and the picture goes black, which
may indicate a lamp rupture (LED indication #3, page 99).
WARNING: RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK!
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, NEVER
REMOVE TV COVERS, EXCEPT AS SPECIFIED
HEREIN. REFER ALL SERVICING NOT SPECIFIED IN
THIS MANUAL TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
Failure to follow this WARNING may result in death
or serious injury.
To obtain a replacement lamp unit:
• In the U.S.:
Web
Contact
The light source for this TV is a mercury lamp with internal
atmospheric pressure that increases during use. The lamp has a
limited service life that varies depending on product use and
user settings.
Call toll-free
1-800-631-3811.
In warranty www.tacp.toshiba.com/service
Consult your
consumer
electronics dealer
for availability.
Out of
warranty
www.ceaccessories.toshiba.com
As is generally the case with all projection TVs that use
projection lamps as a light source, the brightness of the lamp in
this TV may vary somewhat over the expected service life and
will generally decrease over time. The average useful service life
for the lamp is approximately 8,000 hours in Low Power mode
or 6,000 hours in High Bright mode. See “Selecting the Lamp
mode” on page 75 for information on switching the lamp mode.
Because these are averages, some lamps will require earlier
replacement.
• In Canada:
Contact a Toshiba parts distributor by directing your web browser to
www.toshiba.ca. Click “Home Entertainment,” and then click
“Support.”
Use the replacement lamp unit model listed below only.
Using any other lamp may cause damage to the TV
and/or lamp.
Note : The lamp is warranted only for the periods and to the
extent set forth in the Limited Warranty applicable to this set,
which is a substantially shorter period of time than the average
useful service period. See “Limited United States Warranty” on
page 121 or “Limited Canada Warranty” on page 122, as
applicable.
CAUTION: Always replace with same
type lamp unit: Model No. D95-LMP
(Stock no. 23311153)
If you use the lamp beyond its service life:
• you may notice a reduction in the colors and/or brightness of
the picture; and
• the strength of the quartz glass in the lamp will be reduced
and the lamp may rupture (often making a loud noise when
this happens). If the lamp ruptures, the TV will not operate
until the lamp unit is replaced.
CAUTION: Always handle the lamp unit with care.
The lamp unit in this TV was designed for safe replacement
by consumers; however, if the lamp unit is subjected to intentional
abuse (such as excessive mechanical abuse or handling by children
or pets), the unit may break, exposing sharp edges or pinch points.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
119
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 13: Appendix
Lamp unit replacement and care (continued)
4. Using a manual screwdriver, loosen the two screws on the lamp
How to replace the lamp unit
unit.
WARNING: RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK!
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, NEVER
REMOVE TV COVERS, EXCEPT AS SPECIFIED
HEREIN. REFER ALL SERVICING NOT SPECIFIED IN
THIS MANUAL TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
Failure to follow this WARNING may result in death
or serious injury.
Required tools: Lint-free gloves; manual screwdrivers (Phillips
ans slotted).
Lamp unit screws
Optional tool: 5/32" or 4mm Allen
WARNING: RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK!
1. Turn off the TV and unplug the power cord.
The lamp unit door is provided with an
WARNING: Eye damage may result from
directly viewing the light produced by this
lamp. Always turn off the TV and unplug the
interlock to reduce the risk of electric shock and excessive
ultraviolet radiation. Never defeat its purpose or attempt
to service without removing the lamp unit door
completely. Failure to follow this WARNING may result in
death or serious injury.
power cord before opening the lamp unit door.
2. STOP! Allow the lamp to cool for at least one (1) hour
before replacing it.
5. Grasp the lamp unit handle and gently pull the lamp unit
straight out of the TV. Set the old lamp unit aside (see
“Disposing of the used lamp unit” on page 105).
CAUTION: HOT SURFACE!
The temperature of the lamp
immediately after use
exceeds 392°F (200°C).
Touching the lamp before it has cooled will result in
severe burns. ALLOW THE LAMP TO COOL FOR AT
LEAST ONE (1) HOUR BEFORE REPLACING IT.
3. On the lamp unit door on the side of the TV, loosen the screw
using a manual screwdriver, and then remove the lamp unit
door.
Loosen
screw using
TV back
manual
screwdriver
Note:Wear soft, lint-free
gloves when replacing
the lamp unit.
(continued on next page)
Lamp unit door detail
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
120
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 13: Appendix
Lamp unit replacement and care (continued)
8. Reattach the lamp unit door, making sure to insert the hooks
on the left side of the lamp unit door inside the opening in
the TV cabinet.
How to replace the lamp unit (continued)
6. Carefully insert the new lamp unit straight into the TV until
it is fully seated.
Insert the hooks inside
the TV cabinet opening.
Lamp unit door
9. Replace the screw and hand-tighten using a manual screwdriver.
Note :
Hand tighten using
manual screwdriver
• Never subject the lamp unit to excessive shock.
• Never touch the lamp unit glass or otherwise get it dirty.
Doing so may affect the image quality and reduce the service life of
the lamp. See “Cleaning the lamp unit glass” below.
Lamp unit door
NOTE : Make sure
the lamp unit door is
installed securely; otherwise,
the TV may not turn on.
CLEANING THE LAMP UNIT GLASS
If you accidentally touch the lamp unit glass or otherwise
get it dirty, wipe it with a lint-free lens cleaning cloth (such
as a cloth for cleaning camera lenses or eyeglasses).
10. Plug in the power cord and turn on the TV. After the initial
warmup period (which may take several seconds for full
picture brightness), the TV should operate normally. If any of
the following conditions exist, turn off the TV, unplug the
power cord, and repeat steps 1–9 to ensure that the lamp unit
and lamp unit door are installed correctly:
CAUTION: NEVER clean a hot lamp with
any type of flammable liquid or aerosol
cleaning agent. Many ordinary cleaning agents
• No picture • Dark picture • TV will not turn on
(such as glass cleaners) contain chemicals that may be
flammable at certain temperatures. If the lamp unit is not allowed
to cool for at least one (1) hour, such chemicals may ignite.
If, after repeating steps 1–9, the problem still exists:
• In the U.S., call TACP consumer solutions at 1-800-631-3811.
• In Canada, locate the nearest Toshiba authorized service
depot by directing your web browser to www.toshiba.ca;
click “Home Entertainment,” and then click “Support.”
7. Using a manual screwdriver, tighten the two lamp unit screws.
Note: Hand-tighten only. Do not use an electric screwdriver.
Disposing of the used lamp unit
• Place the used lamp unit in the empty box from the new unit.
• Keep the lamp unit out of reach of children and pets.
CAUTION: Always handle the lamp unit with care.
The lamp unit in this TV was designed for safe replacement by
consumers; however, if the lamp unit is subjected to intentional or
accidental abuse (such as excessive mechanical abuse or handling by
children or pets), the unit may break, exposing sharp edges or pinch points.
Lamp unit screws
(use manual screwdriver only)
• Dispose of the used lamp unit by the approved method for
your area.
NOTE : The lamp unit contains mercury. Disposal of mercury may
be regulated due to environmental considerations. For disposal or
recycling information, contact your local authorities or the Electronic Industries
Alliance (www.eiae.org).
NOTE : Make sure the lamp unit and screws
are installed securely; otherwise, the TV may not
turn on and the lamp life may be shortened.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
121
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 13: Appendix
Specifications
NOTE:
• This model complies with the specifications listed below.
• Designs and specifications are subject to change without notice.
• This model may not be compatible with features and/or specifications that may be added in the future.
Television System
Video/Audio Terminals (continued)
HDMI™ INPUT:
NTSC standard
ATSC standard (8VSB)
Digital Cable (64 QAM, 256 QAM; in-the-clear, unencrypted*)
HDMI compliant (type A connector)
HDCP compliant
E-EDID** compliant
Suggested formats: 1080i, 480p, 480i, 720p
HDMI Audio: 2-channel PCM; 32/44.1/48 kHz sampling
frequency; 16/20/24 bits per sample
*Encrypted channels can be viewed on this TV
using a CableCARD.™ See page 12 for details.
Channel Coverage
VHF: 2 through 13
UHF: 14 through 69
NOTE: This TV does not provide HDMI OUTPUT.
VIDEO/AUDIO OUTPUT (also for recording):
VIDEO: 1 V(p-p), 75 ohm, negative sync.
AUDIO: 150 mV(rms) (30% modulation equivalent,
2.2 k ohm or less)
Cable TV: Mid band (A-8 through A-1, A through I)
Super band (J through W)
Hyper band (AA through ZZ, AAA, BBB)
Ultra band (65 through 94, 100 through 135)
VARIABLE AUDIO OUTPUT:
0–300 mV(rms) (30% modulation equivalent,
2.2 k ohm or less)
Power Source
120 V AC, 60 Hz
G-LINK™ and IR OUTPUT:
Power Consumption
3 V(p-p), 3.5 mm mono socket (IR blaster cables supplied)
XX W (average)
XX W in standby mode (using a CableCARD™)
IEEE1394 INPUT/OUTPUT:
XX W in standby mode (without a CableCARD™)
IEEE1394 compliant 4-pin
DIGITAL AUDIO OUTPUT:
Optical type
Audio Power
XXX W + XXX W
PC IN:
Mini D-sub 15 pin Analog RGB
Speaker Type
PC AUDIO IN: 3.5 mm stereo mini jack
Main: Two XXX-inch (XXXcm) round
Tweeter: Two XXX-inch (XXXcm) round
RJ-45 port:
Dimensions
Video/Audio Terminals
56MX195: Width: XXX inches (XXX mm)
Height: XXX inches (XXX mm)
Depth: XXX inches (XXX mm)
62MX195: Width: XXX inches (XXX mm)
Height: XXX inches (XXX mm)
Depth: XXX inches (XXX mm)
72MX195: Width: XXX inches (XXX mm)
Height: XXX inches (XXX mm)
Depth: XXX inches (XXX mm)
Weight
56MX195: XXX lbs (XXX kg)
62MX195: XXX lbs (XXX kg)
72MX195: XXX lbs (XXX kg)
Supplied Accessories
• Two dual-wand IR blaster cables
• Remote control with two size “AA” alkaline batteries
• Owner’s Manual (this book)
Optional Stands:
S-VIDEO INPUT:
Y : 1 V(p-p), 75 ohm, negative sync.
C : 0.286 V(p-p) (burst signal), 75 ohm
VIDEO/AUDIO INPUT:
VIDEO: 1 V(p-p), 75 ohm, negative sync.
AUDIO: 150 mV(rms) (30% modulation equivalent,
22 k ohm or greater)
ColorStream® (component video) HD INPUT:
Y : 1V(p-p), 75 ohm
PR: 0.7 V(p-p), 75 ohm
PB: 0.7 V(p-p), 75 ohm
AUDIO: 150 mV(rms), 22 k ohm or greater
Suggested formats: 1080i, 480p, 480i, 720p
NOTE: This TV does not provide ColorStream HD OUTPUT.
56MX195: STxxxx
62MX195: STxxxx
_________
** E-EDID = Enhanced-Extended Display Identification
72MX195: STxxxx
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
122
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 13: Appendix
Limited United States Warranty
for DLP™ Television Models
Toshiba America Consumer Products, L.L.C. (“TACP”) makes the following
limited warranties to original consumers in the United States.
Your Responsibility
THE ABOVE WARRANTIES ARE SUBJECT TO THE FOLLOWING
CONDITIONS:
(1) You must retain your original bill of sale or provide other proof of
purchase..
(2) All warranty servicing of this DLP™ Television must be performed by an
Authorized TACP Service Station.
THESE LIMITED WARRANTIES EXTEND TO THE ORIGINAL
CONSUMER PURCHASER OR ANY PERSON RECEIVING THIS DLP™
TELEVISION AS A GIFT FROM THE ORIGINAL CONSUMER
PURCHASER AND TO NO OTHER PURCHASER OR TRANSFEREE.
(3) The warranties from TACP are effective only if this DLP™ Television is
purchased and operated in the Continental U.S.A. or Puerto Rico.
(4) Labor service charges for set installation, setup, adjustment of customer
controls, and installation or repair of antenna systems are not covered
by this warranty. Reception problems caused by inadequate antenna
systems, misaligned satellite dishes, cable television distribution, VCRs,
DVD players/recorders, personal computer level IEEE1394 devices, and
any other connected signal source device are your responsibility..
(5) Warranties extend only to defects in materials or workmanship as limited
above, and do not extend to any DLP™ Television or parts that have
been lost or discarded by you or to damage to the DLP™ Television or
parts caused by fires, misuse, accident, Acts of God (such as lightning
or fluctuations in electric power), improper installation, improper
maintenance, or use in violation of instructions furnished by TACP; use
or malfunction through simultaneous use of this DLP™ Television and
connected equipment; or to units that have been modified or had the
serial number removed, altered, defaced, or rendered illegible.
DLP™ TELEVISIONS PURCHASED IN THE U.S.A. AND USED ANYWHERE
OUTSIDE OF THE U.S.A., INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, CANADA
AND MEXICO, ARE NOT COVERED BY THESE WARRANTIES.
DLP™ TELEVISIONS PURCHASED ANYWHERE OUTSIDE OF THE U.S.A.,
INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, CANADA AND MEXICO, AND USED
IN THE U.S.A., ARE NOT COVERED BY THESE WARRANTIES.
Limited One (1) Year Warranty on Parts and Labor
TACP warrants this DLP™ Television and its parts against defects in materials
or workmanship for a period of one (1) year after the date of original retail
purchase. DURING THIS PERIOD, TACP WILL, AT TACP’S OPTION,
REPAIR OR REPLACE A DEFECTIVE PART WITH A NEW OR
REFURBISHED PART WITHOUT CHARGE TO YOU FOR PARTS OR
LABOR. During this period, TACP Authorized Service Station personnel will
come to your home when warranty service is required. Depending on the
type of repair required, the service will either be performed in your home or
the DLP™ Television will be taken to a TACP Authorized Service Station for
repair and returned to your home at no cost to you.
How to Obtain Warranty Service
If, after following all of the operating instructions in this manual and reviewing
the section titled “Troubleshooting,” you find that service is needed:
(1) To find the nearest TACP Authorized Service Station, visit TACP’s
website at www.tacp.toshiba.com/service or contact TACP’s
Consumer Solution Center toll free at 1-800-631-3811.
(2) You must present your original bill of sale or other proof of purchase to
the TACP Authorized Service Station.
Limited One (1) Year Warranty on Lamp Unit
TACP warrants the original lamp unit contained in this DLP™ Television
against defects in materials or workmanship for a period of one (1) year after
the date of original retail purchase. DURING THIS PERIOD, TACP WILL,
AT TACP’S OPTION, EXCHANGE A DEFECTIVE LAMP UNIT WITH A
NEW OR REFURBISHED LAMP UNIT WITHOUT CHARGE TO YOU.
LABOR CHARGES FOR LAMP UNIT REPLACEMENT ARE YOUR
RESPONSIBILITY AND ARE NOT COVERED UNDER THIS
For additional information, visit TACP’s web site:
www.tacp.toshiba.com.
ALL WARRANTIES IMPLIED BY THE LAW OF ANY STATE OF THE
U.S.A., INCLUDING THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
WARRANTY. The lamp unit is a user-replaceable component.
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE,
ARE EXPRESSLY LIMITED TO THE DURATION OF THE LIMITED
WARRANTIES SET FORTH ABOVE. WITH THE EXCEPTION OF ANY
WARRANTIES IMPLIED BY THE LAW OF ANY STATE OF THE U.S.A. AS
HEREBY LIMITED, THE FOREGOING WARRANTY IS EXCLUSIVE AND
IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, GUARANTEES, AGREEMENTS,
AND SIMILAR OBLIGATIONS OF TACP WITH RESPECT TO THE
REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT OF ANY PARTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL
TACP BE LIABLE FOR CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, LOST PROFITS, BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION, OR MODIFICATION OR ERASURE OF RECORDED
DATA CAUSED BY USE, MISUSE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DLP™
TELEVISION).
No person, agent, distributor, dealer, or company is authorized to change,
modify, or extend the terms of these warranties in any manner whatsoever.
The time within which an action must be commenced to enforce any
obligation of TACP arising under the warranty or under any statute or law of
the United States or any state thereof is hereby limited to ninety (90) days
from the date you discover, or should have discovered, the defect. This
limitation does not apply to implied warranties arising under the law of any
state of the U.S.A.
Rental Units
The warranty for DLP™ Television rental units begins on the date of the first
rental or thirty (30) days after the date of shipment to the rental firm,
whichever comes first.
Limited Warranty for Commercial Units
TACP warrants DLP™ Televisions, including the lamp units contained therein,
that are sold and used for commercial purposes as follows: all parts are
warranted against defects in materials or workmanship for a period of ninety
(90) days after the date of original retail purchase. DURING THIS PERIOD,
TACP WILL, AT TACP’S OPTION, REPAIR OR REPLACE A DEFECTIVE
PART WITH A NEW OR REFURBISHED PART WITHOUT CHARGE TO
YOU.
Owner’s Manual and Product Registration
Read this owner’s manual thoroughly before operating this DLP™ television.
Complete and mail the enclosed product registration card or register your
DLP™ Television online at www.tacp.toshiba.com/service as soon as
possible. By registering your DLP™ Television you will enable TACP to bring
you new products specifically designed to meet your needs and help us to
contact you in the unlikely event a safety notification is required under the
Consumer Product Safety Act. Failure to register your product does not
diminish your warranty rights.
THIS WARRANTY GIVES YOU SPECIFIC LEGAL RIGHTS AND YOU
MAY ALSO HAVE OTHER RIGHTS WHICH MAY VARY FROM STATE
TO STATE IN THE U.S.A. SOME STATES OF THE U.S.A. DO NOT ALLOW
LIMITATIONS ON THE DURATION OF AN IMPLIED WARRANTY,
WHEN AN ACTION MAY BE BROUGHT, OR THE EXCLUSION OR
LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES.
THEREFORE, THE ABOVE PROVISIONS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU
UNDER SUCH CIRCUMSTANCES.
05
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
123
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 11: Appendix
Limited Canada Warranty
for DLP™ Television Models
Toshiba of Canada Limited (“TCL”) makes the following limited warranties to
original consumers in Canada.
Your Responsibility
THE ABOVE WARRANTIES ARE SUBJECT TO THE FOLLOWING
CONDITIONS:
(1) You must provide your bill of sale or other proof of purchase.
(2) All warranty servicing of this DLP™ television must be performed by an
Authorized TCL Service Depot.
(3) These warranties from TCL are effective only if the DLP™ television is
purchased in Canada from an authorized TCL dealer and operated in
Canada.
THESE LIMITED WARRANTIES EXTEND TO THE ORIGINAL
CONSUMER PURCHASER OR ANY PERSON RECEIVING THIS DLP™
TELEVISION AS A GIFT FROM THE ORIGINAL CONSUMER
PURCHASER AND TO NO OTHER PURCHASER OR TRANSFEREE.
PRODUCTS PURCHASED IN THE U.S.A. AND USED IN CANADA ARE
NOT COVERED BY THESE WARRANTIES.
(4) Labor charges for installation, setup, adjustment of customer controls,
and installation or repair of antenna systems are not covered by these
warranties. Reception problems caused by inadequate antenna systems
are your responsibility.
PRODUCTS PURCHASED IN CANADA AND USED IN THE U.S.A. ARE
NOT COVERED BY THESE WARRANTIES.
Limited One (1) Year Warranty on Parts and Labor*
(5) Warranties extend only to defects in materials or workmanship as limited
above, and do not extend to any DLP™ television or parts that have
been lost or discarded by you or to damage to the television or parts
caused by fires, misuse, accident, Acts of God (such as lightning or
fluctuations in electric power), improper installation, improper
maintenance, or use in violation of instructions furnished by TCL; use or
malfunction through simultaneous use of this product and connected
equipment; or to units that have been modified or had the serial number
removed, altered, defaced, or rendered illegible.
TCL warrants this DLP™ television television and its parts against defects in
materials or workmanship for a period of one (1) year after the date of
original retail purchase. DURING THIS PERIOD, TCL WILL, AT TCL’S
OPTION, REPAIR OR REPLACE A DEFECTIVE PART WITH A NEW OR
REFURBISHED PART WITHOUT CHARGE TO YOU FOR PARTS OR
LABOR. TCL Authorized Service Depot personnel will come to your home
when warranty service is required. Depending on the type of repair required,
either the service will be performed in your home or the set will be taken to
the TCL Authorized Service Depot for repair and returned to your home at
no cost to you. IN-HOME SERVICE ONLY APPLIES WITHIN 100
KILOMETERS OF AN AUTHORIZED TCL SERVICE DEPOT.
How to Obtain Warranty Services
If, after following all of the operating instructions in this manual and checking
the “Troubleshooting” section, you find that service is needed:
Limited One (1) Year Warranty on Lamp Unit*
(1) To find the nearest TCL Authorized Service Depot, visit TCL’s web site at
www.toshiba.ca.
(2) Present your bill of sale or other proof of purchase to the Authorized
Service Depot.
TCL warrants the lamp unit in this DLP™ television against defects in
materials or workmanship for a period of one (1) year after the date of
original retail purchase. DURING THIS PERIOD, TCL WILL, AT TCL’S
OPTION, EXCHANGE A DEFECTIVE LAMP UNIT WITH A NEW OR
REFURBISHED LAMP UNIT WITHOUT CHARGE TO YOU. LABOR
CHARGES FOR LAMP UNIT REPLACEMENT ARE NOT COVERED
UNDER WARRANTY. The lamp unit is a user-replaceable component.
For additional information, visit TCL’s web site:
www.toshiba.ca
ALL WARRANTIES IMPLIED BY THE LAW OF ANY PROVINCE OF
CANADA, INCLUDING THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
Rental Units
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE,
ARE EXPRESSLY LIMITED TO THE DURATION OF THE LIMITED
WARRANTIES SET FORTH ABOVE. WITH THE EXCEPTION OF ANY
WARRANTIES IMPLIED BY THE LAW OF ANY PROVINCE OF CANADA
AS HEREBY LIMITED, THE FOREGOING WARRANTY IS EXCLUSIVE
AND IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, GUARANTEES,
AGREEMENTS, AND SIMILAR OBLIGATIONS OF TCL WITH RESPECT
TO THE REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT OF ANY PARTS. IN NO EVENT
SHALL TCL BE LIABLE FOR CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, LOST PROFITS,
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, OR MODIFICATION OR ERASURE OF
RECORDED DATA CAUSED BY USE, MISUSE, OR INABILITY TO USE
THIS PRODUCT).
The warranty for rental units, including the lamp units contained therein,
begins with the date of first rental or thirty (30) days from the date of
shipment to the rental firm, whichever comes first.
*Limited Warranty for Commercial Units
TCL warrants DLP™ televisions, including the lamp units contained therein,
sold and used for commercial purposes as follows: all parts are warranted
against defects in materials or workmanship for a period of ninety (90) days
after the date of original purchase. DURING THIS PERIOD, TCL WILL, AT
TCL’S OPTION, REPAIR OR REPLACE A DEFECTIVE PART WITH A NEW OR
REFURBISHED PART WITHOUT CHARGE TO YOU. ON-SITE SERVICE
ONLY APPLIES WITHIN 100 KILOMETERS OF AN AUTHORIZED TCL
SERVICE DEPOT.
No person, agent, distributor, dealer, or company is authorized to change,
modify, or extend the terms of these warranties in any manner whatsoever.
The time within which action must be commenced to enforce any obligation
of TCL arising under this warranty or under any law of Canada or of any
province thereof is hereby limited to 90 days from the date you discover, or
should have discovered, the defect. This limitation does not apply to implied
warranties arising under the law of any province of Canada.
Owner’s Manual and Product Registration
Read this owner’s manual thoroughly before operating this DLP™ television.
Register your product online at www.toshiba.ca as soon as possible. By
registering your product you will enable TCL bring you new products
specifically designed to meet your needs and help us to contact you in the
unlikely event a safety notification is required under the Consumer Product
Safety Act. Failure to register your product does not diminish your warranty
rights.
THIS WARRANTY GIVES YOU SPECIFIC LEGAL RIGHTS, AND YOU
MAY ALSO HAVE OTHER RIGHTS, WHICH MAY VARY FROM
PROVINCE TO PROVINCE IN CANADA. SOME PROVINCES OF
CANADA DO NOT ALLOW LIMITATIONS ON THE DURATION OF AN
IMPLIED WARRANTY, LIMITATIONS ON THE TIME WITHIN WHICH AN
ACTION MAY BE BROUGHT, OR THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF
INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES; THEREFORE, THE
ABOVE LIMITATIONS OR EXCLUSIONS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU
UNDER SUCH CIRCUMSTANCES.
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
124
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 13: Appendix
A copy of the GPL source code in this product may be obtained by
contacting Toshiba Consumer Solutions at (800)631-3811. There will be a
charge to cover the costs of providing the source code.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT “AS IS” AND
ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. This product includes
cryptographic software written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). This
product includes software written by Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com).
A copy of the LGPL source code in this product may be obtained by
contacting Toshiba Consumer Solutions at (800)631-3811. There will be a
charge to cover the costs of providing the source code.
USB Protocol Copyright © 2005 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc. All rights
reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are
met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
Copyright © 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). All Rights reserved.
This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young
(eay@cryptsoft.com). The implementation was written so as to conform with
Netscapes SSL. This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use
so long as the following conditions are adhered to. The following conditions
apply to all code found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, Ihash, DES,
etc., code; not just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with this
distribution is covered by the same copyright terms except that the holder is
Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com).
3. Neither the name of The NetBSD Foundation nor the names of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from
this software without specified prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC.
AND CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;
OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY
WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Copyright remains Eric Young’s, and as such any Copyright notices in the
code are not to be removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric
Young should be given attribution as the author of the parts of the library
used. This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or in
documentation (online or textual) provided with the package.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must
display the following acknowledgement: “This product includes
cryptographic software written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com).” The
word ‘cryptographic’ can be left out if the routines from the library being
used are not cryptographic related.
This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in
the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org).
This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young
(eay@cryptsoft.com).
OpenSSL 0.9.7d Copyright © 1998-2000 the OpenSSL Project. All Rights
reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must
display the following acknowledgement: This product includes software
developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit
(http://openssl.org).
4. The names “OpenSSL Toolkit” and “Open SSL Project” must not be used
to endorse or promote products derived from this software without prior
written permission. For written permission, please contact openssl-
core@openssl.org.
5. Products derived from this software may not be called “OpenSSL” nor may
“Open SSL” appear in their names without prior written permission of the
OpenSSL Project.
6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
acknowledgement: “This product includes software developed by the
OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org).”
4. If you include any Windows specific code (or derivative thereof) from the
apps directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement:
“This product includes software written by Tim Hudson
(tjh@cryptosoft.com).”
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG “AS IS” AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL
THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;
OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY
WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. The license and distribution terms for
any publicly available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed,
i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put under another distribution
license (including the GNU Public License).
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
125
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Index
A
E F G H I J
Antenna cables ......................................................................... 11
Audio player ............................................................................... 87
Audio quality adjustments.................................................... 85
Audio system connection...................................................... 20
Auto aspect................................................................................. 74
Auto power off........................................................................... 92
AVHD ..................................................................................... 23, 50
EIA-775......................................................................................... 22
FAV SCAN button .............................................................. 44, 78
Factory defaults, restore TV .......................................... 52, 79
Favorite channels .............................................................. 44, 78
Features, TV ...................................................................................7
Focus ............................................................................................. 86
Front of the TV..............................................................................9
GameTimer™ .............................................................................. 96
G-LINK™ connection .............................................................. 25
HDMI™ connection ................................................................. 19
IEEE1394...................................................................................... 22
INPUT button ............................................................................. 67
Input lock..................................................................................... 95
Installation, care, and service............................................ 3, 4
Installation, setup ........................................................................8
Integrated digital tuning...........................................................7
IR blaster ..................................................................................... 21
JPEG ....................................................................................... 87–90
B
Back of the TV ........................................................................... 10
Blocking channels.................................................................... 95
C
Cable box connection...................................................... 14, 16
CableCARD™ ............................................................................. 12
CableClear® DNR ..................................................................... 80
Cables ........................................................................................... 11
Camcorder connection........................................................... 13
CH yz buttons .................................................................. 42, 71
Channel Browser™........................................................................
CH RTN button .......................................................................... 71
Channel Number buttons .............................................. 42, 71
Channel programming:
Automatic programming .................................................. 42
Manually adding and deleting ....................................... 43
Cinema mode............................................................................. 75
Closed captions ........................................................................ 82
Color temperature .................................................................... 80
ColorStream® ...................................................................... 10, 17
Connecting devices .......................................................... 12–25
Control panel lock................................................................... XX
CompactFlash® memory cards .....................................87, 88
Component video cables ...................................................... 11
Component video (ColorStream®) .............................. 10, 17
L
Labeling video inputs ............................................................. 68
Lamp mode ................................................................................. 75
Lamp unit replacement .............................................. 103–105
Language selection ................................................................. 41
Last mode memory feature .................................................. 92
LED indications ............................................................... 8, 9, 99
Locking video inputs............................................................... 95
LOCKS menu.............................................................................. 93
Channels, blocking ............................................................. 95
Enable rating blocking ...................................................... 94
GameTimer™ ......................................................................... 96
New PIN code ...................................................................... 93
Unlocking programs temporarily .................................. 95
Video inputs, locking ......................................................... 95
D
M
Device connections .......................................................... 12–25
Defaults, restore TV factory ................................................. 52
Digital Audio Out...................................................................... 20
Digital signal meter ................................................................. 52
DNR (Digital Noise Reduction) .......................................... 80
Dolby Digital........................................................................ 20, 86
Double-window POP feature............................................... 76
DVD player connection................................................... 16, 17
D-VHS .................................................................................... 23, 50
DVI connection.......................................................................... 19
Dynamic Contrast..................................................................... 81
Memory cards..................................................................... 87–90
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
126
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Index
(continued)
Memory Stick™ memory cards .....................................87, 88
Menu system....................................................................... 35, 36
MMC memory cards .........................................................87, 88
MP3......................................................................................... 87–90
MPEG-2 digital video signals .............................................. 22
MPEG Noise Reduction ......................................................... 81
MTS feature ................................................................................ 84
MUTE button.............................................................................. 84
S
Safety, care, installation, and service ............................. 2–5
SAP sound................................................................................... 84
Satellite receiver connection ............................................... 15
Scrolling the TheaterWide® picture................................... 74
SD (Secure Digital™) memory cards .......................... 87, 88
Service .............................................................................................4
Setup, TV...............................................................................36, 41
Setup, TV Guide On Screen™ system............................... 37
Sleep timer .................................................................................. 91
Speakers ON/OFF .................................................................... 86
Specifications...........................................................................106
SRS 3D ......................................................................................... 86
SRS WOW™ ................................................................................ 86
StableSound® ............................................................................. 85
Stereo sound .............................................................................. 84
Sub-bass (SBS)......................................................................... 85
S-video cables ........................................................................... 11
Symbio™ AVHD recorder ............................................... 23, 50
System status ............................................................................. 52
O P Q
ON/OFF timer ............................................................................ 91
Optical audio cable ................................................................. 11
Picture adjustments:
Color temperature............................................................... 80
Picture mode ......................................................................... 79
Picture quality ....................................................................... 79
Picture-out-picture (POP):
FAV SCAN button................................................................ 78
SPLIT button.......................................................................... 76
Picture scroll............................................................................... 74
Picture size selection .............................................................. 73
Picture viewer ............................................................................ 87
Problems with TV ...............................................................97, 98
Quick Restart ............................................................................. 51
T
TheaterNet™ DEVICE and CONTROL buttons ............. 46
TheaterNet™ control ............................................................... 21
TheaterNet™ setup .................................................................. 45
TheaterWide® picture size .................................................... 73
Time and date setting............................................................. 50
Troubleshooting ..................................................................97, 98
TruBass ......................................................................................... 86
TV control panel .............................................................. XX, XX
TV Guide On Screen™ ................................................. 8, 37, 53
R
RECALL button ......................................................................... 84
Remote control:
Battery installation .............................................................. 28
Device code table ........................................................ 33, 34
Effective range...................................................................... 27
Functional key chart.................................................... 29, 30
Learning about the buttons ............................................ 26
Operational feature reset ................................................. 32
Programming ........................................................................ 31
Searching and sampling the code ............................... 31
Volume lock feature ........................................................... 32
Restart, Quick ............................................................................ 51
Restore TV factory defaults.................................................. 52
V
V-Chip blocking (Locks menu) .................................... 93–95
VCR connection ................................................................. 13–18
Video cables ............................................................................... 11
Video input labels .................................................................... 68
Video input lock ........................................................................ 95
W, X
Warranty........................................................................... 121, 122
WOW™, SRS®
...................................................................................................................................... 86
xD-Picture Card™ ...............................................................87, 88
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
127
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
TOSHIBA AMERICA CONSUMER PRODUCTS, L.L.C.
HEAD OFFICE: 82 TOTOWA ROAD, WAYNE, NJ 07470, U.S.A.
NATIONAL SERVICE DIVISION:1420-B TOSHIBA DRIVE, LEBANON, TN 37087, U.S.A.
TOSHIBA OF CANADA LTD.
HEAD OFFICE: 191 McNABB STREET, MARKHAM, ONTARIO, L3R 8H2, CANADA – TEL: (905) 470-5400
SERVICE CENTERS:
TORONTO: 191 McNABB STREET, MARKHAM, ONTARIO L3R 8H2, CANADA – TEL: (905) 470- 5400
MONTREAL: 18050 TRANS CANADA, KIRKLAND, QUEBEC, H9J 4A1, CANADA – TEL: (514) 390-7766
VANCOUVER: 22171 FRASERWOOD WAY, RICHMOND, B.C., V6W 1J5, CANADA – TEL: (604) 303-2500
MANUFACTURED BY
TOSHIBA AMERICA CONSUMER PRODUCTS, L.L.C.
CableClear, CinemaSeries, ColorStream, StableSound, and TheaterWide are registered trademarks of Toshiba America Consumer Products, L.L.C.
ChannelBrowser, GameTimer, SurfLock, Symbio, and TheaterNet are trademarks of Toshiba America Consumer Products, L.L.C.
Digital Light Processing, DLP™ and the DLP medallion are trademarks of Texas Instruments.
PRINTED IN USA
(05-08)
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
YC/N 23566730
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|
TC electronic SDN BHD Stereo Amplifier D22 User Manual
Technicolor Thomson DVD Recorder DMR EH80V User Manual
Telex Intercom System BKP 4 User Manual
TP Link Switch TL SG2216WEB User Manual
Triarch Indoor Furnishings 75257 14 User Manual
Tricity Bendix Dishwasher BDW 52 User Manual
ViewSonic CRT Television VX2409 User Manual
Viking Camera Accessories SSFDC A2 User Manual
Viking Refrigerator VIRB364 User Manual
Vornado Electric Heater EH1008406 User Manual